blob: 01a07646d06e9b1bac208ba6236d8cf9acebebae [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau991b4782015-10-13 21:48:10 +02005 version 1.7
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau608efa12016-10-25 22:22:00 +02007 2016/10/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110
1111. Quick reminder about HTTP
112----------------------------
113
114When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
115fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
116on almost anything found in the contents.
117
118However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
119formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
120correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
121
122
1231.1. The HTTP transaction model
124-------------------------------
125
126The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100127to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
129connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
130will involve a new connection :
131
132 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
133
134In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
135establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
136by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
137length.
138
139Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
140to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
141however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
142response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
143header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
148power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
149but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200150a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151
152A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
153keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
154second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
155page :
156
157 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
158
159This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
160latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
161correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
162the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100163server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100165By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
166connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
167leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
168start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100170HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
171 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
172 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
173 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
174 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
175 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
176 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
1791.2. HTTP request
180-----------------
181
182First, let's consider this HTTP request :
183
184 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100185 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
187 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
188 3 User-agent: my small browser
189 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
190 5 Accept: image/png
191
192
1931.2.1. The Request line
194-----------------------
195
196Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
197
198 - a METHOD : GET
199 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
201
202All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
203which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
204followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
205is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
206desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
207the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
208
209The URI itself can have several forms :
210
211 - A "relative URI" :
212
213 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
214
215 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
216 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
217
218 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
219
220 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221
222 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
223 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
224 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
225 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
226 must accept this form too.
227
228 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
229 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
230 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
233 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
234 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
235 other protocols too.
236
237In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
238mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
239on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
240It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
241specific to the language, framework or application in use.
242
243
2441.2.2. The request headers
245--------------------------
246
247The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
248beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
249an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
250Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
251values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
252encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
253the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
254define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
255
256Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
257their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
258"Connection:" header).
259
260The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
261that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
262is one valid form of empty line.
263
264Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
265headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
266about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
267application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
268
269Important note:
270 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
271 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
272 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
273 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
274
275
2761.3. HTTP response
277------------------
278
279An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
280messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
281
282 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100283 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
285 2 Content-length: 350
286 3 Content-Type: text/html
287
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
289codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
290response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100291continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
292the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
293following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
294sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
295(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
296correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
297such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
298state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
299over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
300if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
301information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200303
3041.3.1. The Response line
305------------------------
306
307Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
308
309 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
310 - a status code : 200
311 - a reason : OK
312
313The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200314 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200315 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
316 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
317 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
318 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
319
320Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100321"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
323messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
324or "Authentication Required".
325
326Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
327
328 Code When / reason
329 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
330 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100333 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
334 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200335 400 for an invalid or too large request
336 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
337 accessing the stats page)
338 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
339 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
340 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
341 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
342 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
343 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
344 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
345 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
346 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
347
348The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3494.2).
350
351
3521.3.2. The response headers
353---------------------------
354
355Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
356the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
357details.
358
359
3602. Configuring HAProxy
361----------------------
362
3632.1. Configuration file format
364------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200365
366HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
367
368 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
369 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
370 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
371 "frontend" and "backend".
372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100373The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
374referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200375delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003782.2. Quoting and escaping
379-------------------------
380
381HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
382many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
383with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
384single quotes.
385
386If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
387them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
388escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
389
390Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
391
392 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
393 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
394 \\ to use a backslash
395 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
396 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
397
398Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
399the interpretation of:
400
401 space as a parameter separator
402 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
403 # hash as a comment start
404
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200405Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
406-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
407backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
408
409Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200410quoting.
411
412Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
413nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
414
415Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
416equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
417
418 Example:
419 # those are equivalents:
420 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
421 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
422 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
425
426 # those are equivalents:
427 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
431
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004332.3. Environment variables
434--------------------------
435
436HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
437interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
438configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
439optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
440shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
441underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
442
443 Example:
444
445 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
446
447 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
448
449 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
450
451
4522.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200453----------------
454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100455Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100456values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
457otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
458numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
459for every keyword. Supported units are :
460
461 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
462 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
463 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
464 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
465 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
466 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
467
468
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004692.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200470-------------
471
472 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
473 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
474 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
475 global
476 daemon
477 maxconn 256
478
479 defaults
480 mode http
481 timeout connect 5000ms
482 timeout client 50000ms
483 timeout server 50000ms
484
485 frontend http-in
486 bind *:80
487 default_backend servers
488
489 backend servers
490 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
491
492
493 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
494 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
495 global
496 daemon
497 maxconn 256
498
499 defaults
500 mode http
501 timeout connect 5000ms
502 timeout client 50000ms
503 timeout server 50000ms
504
505 listen http-in
506 bind *:80
507 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
508
509
510Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
511
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100512 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200513
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005153. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516--------------------
517
518Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
519are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
520of them have command-line equivalents.
521
522The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
523
524 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200525 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200527 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200528 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200530 - description
531 - deviceatlas-json-file
532 - deviceatlas-log-level
533 - deviceatlas-separator
534 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900535 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536 - gid
537 - group
538 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200539 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100545 - presetenv
546 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - uid
548 - ulimit-n
549 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100550 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200551 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200552 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
553 - ssl-default-bind-options
554 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-server-options
556 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100557 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100558 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100559 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100560 - 51degrees-data-file
561 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200562 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200563 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100564 - wurfl-data-file
565 - wurfl-information-list
566 - wurfl-information-list-separator
567 - wurfl-engine-mode
568 - wurfl-cache-size
569 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100570
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200571 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200572 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200574 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100575 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100576 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100577 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200578 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200579 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200580 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200581 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - noepoll
583 - nokqueue
584 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100585 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300586 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000587 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200588 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200589 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200590 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - tune.buffers.limit
592 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200593 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200594 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100595 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100596 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200597 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100598 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100599 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100600 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100601 - tune.lua.session-timeout
602 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200603 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100604 - tune.maxaccept
605 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200606 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200607 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200608 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100609 - tune.rcvbuf.client
610 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100611 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100612 - tune.sndbuf.client
613 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100614 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100615 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200616 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100617 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200618 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200619 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200620 - tune.vars.global-max-size
621 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
622 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
623 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100624 - tune.zlib.memlevel
625 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100626
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627 * Debugging
628 - debug
629 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200630
631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006323.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633------------------------------------
634
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200635ca-base <dir>
636 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200637 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
638 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200639
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200640chroot <jail dir>
641 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
642 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
643 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
644 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
645 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
646 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100647
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100648cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
649 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
650 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
651 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100652 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
653 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
654 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
655 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
656 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
657 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
658 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
659 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
660 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
661 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100662
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200663crt-base <dir>
664 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
665 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
666 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
667
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200668daemon
669 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
670 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
671 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
672
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200673deviceatlas-json-file <path>
674 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
675 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
676
677deviceatlas-log-level <value>
678 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
679 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
680
681deviceatlas-separator <char>
682 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
683 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
684
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100685deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200686 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
687 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
688 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100689
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900690external-check
691 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
692 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
693 See "option external-check".
694
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695gid <number>
696 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
697 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
698 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100699 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
700 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200701 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100702
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200703group <group name>
704 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
705 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100706
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200707log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200708 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
709 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100710 configured with "log global".
711
712 <address> can be one of:
713
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100714 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100715 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
716 port).
717
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100718 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
719 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
720 port).
721
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100722 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
723 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
724 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
725 writeable).
726
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200727 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
728 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100729
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200730 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
731 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
732 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
733 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
734 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
735 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
736 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
737 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
738 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
739 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
740 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
741
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200742 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
743 one of the following :
744
745 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
746 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
747
748 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
749 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
750
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100751 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200752
753 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
754 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
755 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
756
757 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200758 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
759 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
760 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
761 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
762 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
763 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200764
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200765 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200766
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100767log-send-hostname [<string>]
768 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
769 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
770 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
771 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
772 the logs.
773
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000774log-tag <string>
775 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
776 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
777 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100778 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000779
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100780lua-load <file>
781 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
782 used multiple times.
783
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200784nbproc <number>
785 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
786 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
787 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
788 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
789 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
790
791pidfile <pidfile>
792 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
793 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
794 starting the process. See also "daemon".
795
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100796presetenv <name> <value>
797 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
798 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
799 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
800 and "unsetenv".
801
802resetenv [<name> ...]
803 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
804 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
805 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
806 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
807 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
808 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
809 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
810 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
811
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100812stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200813 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
814 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
815 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
816 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
817 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
818 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100819 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200820 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
821 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200822
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200823server-state-base <directory>
824 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200825 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
826 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200827
828server-state-file <file>
829 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
830 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
831 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
832 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
833 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
834 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
835 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
836 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200837 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
838 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200839
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100840setenv <name> <value>
841 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
842 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
843 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
844 and "unsetenv".
845
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100846ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
847 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
848 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300849 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100850 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
851 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
852 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
853 "bind" keyword for more information.
854
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100855ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
857 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
858 keyword to see available options.
859
860 Example:
861 global
862 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
863
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100864ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
865 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
866 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300867 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100868 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
869 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
870 information.
871
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100872ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
873 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
874 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
875 keyword to see available options.
876
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200877ssl-dh-param-file <file>
878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
879 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
880 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
881 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
882 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200883 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
884 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
885 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
886 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200887 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
888 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
889 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
890
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100891ssl-server-verify [none|required]
892 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
893 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
894 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
895
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200896stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
897 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
898 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
899 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200900 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
901 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200902
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200903 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
904 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
905 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200906
907stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
908 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
909 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100910 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200911
912stats maxconn <connections>
913 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
914 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
915
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200916uid <number>
917 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
918 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
919 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
920 one. See also "gid" and "user".
921
922ulimit-n <number>
923 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
924 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
925 option.
926
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100927unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
928 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
929
930 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
931 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
932 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
933 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
934 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
935 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
936 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
937 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
938 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
939 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
940
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100941unsetenv [<name> ...]
942 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
943 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
944 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
945 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
946 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
947 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
948 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
949
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200950user <user name>
951 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
952 See also "uid" and "group".
953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200954node <name>
955 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
956
957 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
958 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
959 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
960 traffic.
961
962description <text>
963 Add a text that describes the instance.
964
965 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
966 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
967 "<" and ">" characters.
968
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010096951degrees-data-file <file path>
970 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
971 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
972
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200973 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100974 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
975
97651degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
977 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
978 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
979 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
980
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200981 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100982 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
983
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020098451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100985 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
986 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
987
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200988 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
989 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
990
99151degrees-cache-size <number>
992 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
993 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
994 By default, this cache is disabled.
995
996 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100997 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
998
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100999wurfl-data-file <file path>
1000 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1001 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1002
1003 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1004 with USE_WURFL=1.
1005
1006wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1007 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1008 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1009 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1010
1011 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1012
1013 Valid WURFL properties are:
1014 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1015
1016 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1017 device.
1018
1019 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1020 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1021
1022 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1023 particular web request.
1024
1025 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1026 used Libwurfl API version.
1027
1028 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1029 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1030 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1031
1032 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1033 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1034
1035 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1036 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1037
1038 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1039
1040 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1041
1042 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1043 with USE_WURFL=1.
1044
1045wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1046 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1047 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1048
1049 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1050 with USE_WURFL=1.
1051
1052wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1053 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1054 thus before the chroot.
1055
1056 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1057 with USE_WURFL=1.
1058
1059wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1060 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1061 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1062 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1063 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1064 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1065 mode is enabled by default.
1066
1067 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1068 with USE_WURFL=1.
1069
1070wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1071 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1072 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1073 - "0" : no cache is used.
1074 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1075 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1076 the highest performing option.
1077
1078 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1079 with USE_WURFL=1.
1080
1081wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1082 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1083 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1084
1085 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1086 with USE_WURFL=1.
1087
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010893.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001090-----------------------
1091
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001092max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1093 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1094 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1095 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1096 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1097 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1098 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1099 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1100 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1101
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102maxconn <number>
1103 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1104 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1105 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001106 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1107 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1108 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1109 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001110 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1111 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1112 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1113 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1114 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001115
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001116maxconnrate <number>
1117 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1118 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1119 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1120 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1121 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1122 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1123 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1124 fairness.
1125
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001126maxcomprate <number>
1127 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001128 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001129 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1130 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1131 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1132 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1133 default value.
1134
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001135maxcompcpuusage <number>
1136 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1137 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1138 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1139 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1140 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1141 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1142 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1143 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1144
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001145maxpipes <number>
1146 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1147 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1148 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1149 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1150 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1151 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1152
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001153maxsessrate <number>
1154 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1155 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1156 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1157 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1158 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1159 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1160 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1161 fairness.
1162
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001163maxsslconn <number>
1164 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1165 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1166 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1167 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1168 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1169 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1170 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001171 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1172 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1173 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1174 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1175 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1176 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1177 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001178
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001179maxsslrate <number>
1180 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1181 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1182 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1183 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1184 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1185 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1186 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1187 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1188 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1189 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1190
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001191maxzlibmem <number>
1192 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1193 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1194 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001195 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1196 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1197 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1198
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001199noepoll
1200 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1201 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001202 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001203
1204nokqueue
1205 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1206 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1207 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1208
1209nopoll
1210 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1211 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001212 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001213 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001214
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001215nosplice
1216 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1217 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1218 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001219 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001220 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1221 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1222 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1223 "option splice-response".
1224
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001225nogetaddrinfo
1226 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1227 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1228
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001229noreuseport
1230 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1231 command line argument "-dR".
1232
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001233spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001234 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1235 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1236 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1237 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1238 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1239 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001240
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001241tune.buffers.limit <number>
1242 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1243 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1244 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1245 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1246 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1247 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1248 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1249 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1250 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1251 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1252 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1253 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1254 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1255 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1256 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1257
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001258tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1259 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1260 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1261 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1262 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1263
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001264tune.bufsize <number>
1265 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1266 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1267 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1268 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1269 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1270 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1271 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1272 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001273 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1274 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1275 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001276
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001277tune.chksize <number>
1278 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1279 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1280 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1281 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1282 checks whenever possible.
1283
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001284tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1285 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1286 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1287 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1288 this value. The default value is 1.
1289
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001290tune.http.cookielen <number>
1291 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1292 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1293 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1294 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1295 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1296 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1297 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1298 to change this value.
1299
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001300tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1301 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1302 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1303 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1304 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1305 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1306 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1307 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1308 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1309 limit too high.
1310
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001311tune.idletimer <timeout>
1312 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1313 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1314 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1315 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1316 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1317 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1318 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1319 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1320 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1321
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001322tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1323 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1324 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1325 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1326 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1327 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1328 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1329 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1330
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001331tune.lua.maxmem
1332 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1333 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1334 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1335 memory.
1336
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001337tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1338 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001339 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1340 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1341 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001342
1343tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1344 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1345 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1346 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1347 check servers.
1348
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001349tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1350 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1351 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1352 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1353 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1354
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001355tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001356 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1357 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1358 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1359 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1360 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1361 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1362 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1363 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1364 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1365 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001366
1367tune.maxpollevents <number>
1368 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1369 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1370 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1371 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1372 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1373
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001374tune.maxrewrite <number>
1375 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1376 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1377 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1378 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1379 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1380 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1381 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1382 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1383 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1384 bufsize.
1385
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001386tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1387 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1388 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1389 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1390 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1391 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1392 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1393 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1394 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1395 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1396 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1397 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1398 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1399 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1400 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1401 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1402 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1403 setting this parameter to 0.
1404
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001405tune.pipesize <number>
1406 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1407 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1408 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1409 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1410 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1411 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1412
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001413tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1414tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1415 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1416 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1417 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1418 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1419 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1420 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1421 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1422
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001423tune.recv_enough <number>
1424 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1425 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1426 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1427 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1428 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1429
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001430tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1431tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1432 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1433 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1434 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1435 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1436 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1437 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1438 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1439 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1440 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1441 notifying haproxy again.
1442
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001443tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001444 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1445 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1446 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001447 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001448 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1449 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1450 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1451 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1452 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001453 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1454 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001455
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001456tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1457 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1458 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1459 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1460 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1461 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1462 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1463
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001464tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1465 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001466 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001467 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1468 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1469 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1470 being used for too long.
1471
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001472tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1473 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1474 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1475 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1476 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1477 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1478 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1479 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1480 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1481 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1482 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001483 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1484 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001485
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001486tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1487 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1488 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1489 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1490 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1491 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1492 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1493 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001494 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1495 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001496
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001497tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1498 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1499 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1500 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1501 1000 entries.
1502
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001503tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1504tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1505tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1506tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001507 These four tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1508 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available
1509 for all scopes. "sess" limits the memory for the session scope, "txn" for
1510 the transaction scope, and "reqres" limits the memory for each request or
1511 response processing.
1512 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits
1513 include the finer grained ones: "sess" includes "txn", and "txn" includes
1514 "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001515
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001516 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1517 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1518 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1519 all available space is consumed.
1520 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1521 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1522 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001523
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001524tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1525 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001526 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001527 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1528 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1529 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1530
1531tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1532 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1533 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1534 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1535 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001536
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015373.3. Debugging
1538--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001539
1540debug
1541 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1542 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1543 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1544 system startup.
1545
1546quiet
1547 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1548 line argument "-q".
1549
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001550
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015513.4. Userlists
1552--------------
1553It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1554http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1555it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1556
1557userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001558 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001559 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1560
1561group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001562 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001563 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1564 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1565
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001566user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1567 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001568 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1569 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001570 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1571 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001572 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001573 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001574
1575
1576 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001577 userlist L1
1578 group G1 users tiger,scott
1579 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001580
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001581 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1582 user scott insecure-password elgato
1583 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001584
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001585 userlist L2
1586 group G1
1587 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001588
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001589 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1590 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1591 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001592
1593 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001594
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001595
15963.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001597----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001598It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1599several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1600instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1601values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1602automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1603In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1604using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1605tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1606reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1607Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1608that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1609each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001610
1611peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001612 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001613 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1614
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001615disabled
1616 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1617 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1618 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1619
1620enable
1621 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1622
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001623peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1624 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1625 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1626 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1627 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1628 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1629 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1630
1631 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1632 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1633
1634 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1635 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1636 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1637 across all peers.
1638
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001639 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1640 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001641
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001642 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001643 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001644 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1645 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1646 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001647
1648 backend mybackend
1649 mode tcp
1650 balance roundrobin
1651 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1652 stick on src
1653
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001654 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1655 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001656
1657
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090016583.6. Mailers
1659------------
1660It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1661If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1662in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1663
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001664mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001665 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1666 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1667
1668mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1669 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1670
1671 Example:
1672 mailers mymailers
1673 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1674 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1675
1676 backend mybackend
1677 mode tcp
1678 balance roundrobin
1679
1680 email-alert mailers mymailers
1681 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1682 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1683
1684 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1685 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1686
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001687timeout mail <time>
1688 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1689 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1690 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1691 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1692
1693 Example:
1694 mailers mymailers
1695 timeout mail 20s
1696 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016984. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001699----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001701Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001702 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001703 - frontend <name>
1704 - backend <name>
1705 - listen <name>
1706
1707A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1708its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1709section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001710section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001711
1712A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1713connections.
1714
1715A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1716to forward incoming connections.
1717
1718A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1719parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1720
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001721All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1722'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1723case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1724
1725Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1726logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1727proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1728However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1729name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1730
1731Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1732and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001733bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001734protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1735modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1736arbitrary criteria.
1737
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001738In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1739a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1740the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1741
1742 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1743 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1744 between responses and new requests.
1745
1746 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1747 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1748 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1749 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1750
1751 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1752 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1753 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1754
1755 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1756 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1757 client-facing connection remains open.
1758
1759 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1760 after the end of the response.
1761
1762The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1763frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1764following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1765weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1766
1767 Backend mode
1768
1769 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1770 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1771 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1772 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1773 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1774 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1775 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1776 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1777 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1778 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1779 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1780
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001781
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001782
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017834.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1784--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001786The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1787limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1788they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1789limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001790marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001791option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001792and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1793with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1794specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001795
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001796
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001797 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1798------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1799acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001800appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001801backlog X X X -
1802balance X - X X
1803bind - X X -
1804bind-process X X X X
1805block - X X X
1806capture cookie - X X -
1807capture request header - X X -
1808capture response header - X X -
1809clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001810compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001811contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1812cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001813declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001814default-server X - X X
1815default_backend X X X -
1816description - X X X
1817disabled X X X X
1818dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001819email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001820email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001821email-alert mailers X X X X
1822email-alert myhostname X X X X
1823email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001824enabled X X X X
1825errorfile X X X X
1826errorloc X X X X
1827errorloc302 X X X X
1828-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1829errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001830force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001831filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001832fullconn X - X X
1833grace X X X X
1834hash-type X - X X
1835http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001836http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001837http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001838http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001839http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001840http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001841http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001842id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001843ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001844load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001845log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001846log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001847log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001848log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001849max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001850maxconn X X X -
1851mode X X X X
1852monitor fail - X X -
1853monitor-net X X X -
1854monitor-uri X X X -
1855option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1856option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1857option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1858option allbackups (*) X - X X
1859option checkcache (*) X - X X
1860option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1861option contstats (*) X X X -
1862option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1863option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1864option forceclose (*) X X X X
1865-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1866option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001867option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001868option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001869option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001870option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001871option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001872option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001873option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001874option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1875option httpchk X - X X
1876option httpclose (*) X X X X
1877option httplog X X X X
1878option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001879option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001880option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001881option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001882option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1883option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1884option logasap (*) X X X -
1885option mysql-check X - X X
1886option nolinger (*) X X X X
1887option originalto X X X X
1888option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001889option pgsql-check X - X X
1890option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001891option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001892option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001893option smtpchk X - X X
1894option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1895option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1896option splice-request (*) X X X X
1897option splice-response (*) X X X X
1898option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1899option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1900-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001901option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001902option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1903option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1904option tcpka X X X X
1905option tcplog X X X X
1906option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001907external-check command X - X X
1908external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001909persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1910rate-limit sessions X X X -
1911redirect - X X X
1912redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1913redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1914reqadd - X X X
1915reqallow - X X X
1916reqdel - X X X
1917reqdeny - X X X
1918reqiallow - X X X
1919reqidel - X X X
1920reqideny - X X X
1921reqipass - X X X
1922reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001923reqitarpit - X X X
1924reqpass - X X X
1925reqrep - X X X
1926-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001927reqtarpit - X X X
1928retries X - X X
1929rspadd - X X X
1930rspdel - X X X
1931rspdeny - X X X
1932rspidel - X X X
1933rspideny - X X X
1934rspirep - X X X
1935rsprep - X X X
1936server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001937server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001938source X - X X
1939srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001940stats admin - X X X
1941stats auth X X X X
1942stats enable X X X X
1943stats hide-version X X X X
1944stats http-request - X X X
1945stats realm X X X X
1946stats refresh X X X X
1947stats scope X X X X
1948stats show-desc X X X X
1949stats show-legends X X X X
1950stats show-node X X X X
1951stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001952-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1953stick match - - X X
1954stick on - - X X
1955stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001956stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001957stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001958tcp-check connect - - X X
1959tcp-check expect - - X X
1960tcp-check send - - X X
1961tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001962tcp-request connection - X X -
1963tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001964tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02001965tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001966tcp-response content - - X X
1967tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001968timeout check X - X X
1969timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001970timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001971timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1972timeout connect X - X X
1973timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1974timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1975timeout http-request X X X X
1976timeout queue X - X X
1977timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001978timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001979timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1980timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001981timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001982transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001983unique-id-format X X X -
1984unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001985use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001986use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001987------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1988 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001989
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019914.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1992---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001993
1994This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1995
1996
1997acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1998 Declare or complete an access list.
1999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2000 no | yes | yes | yes
2001 Example:
2002 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2003 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2004 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002006 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002007
2008
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002009appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2010 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002011 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2013 no | no | yes | yes
2014 Arguments :
2015 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2016 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2017
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002018 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002019 checked in each cookie value.
2020
2021 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2022 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2023 milliseconds.
2024
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002025 request-learn
2026 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2027 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2028 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2029 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2030 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2031 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2032
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002033 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2034 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2035 data following this prefix.
2036
2037 Example :
2038 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2039
2040 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2041 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2042
2043 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2044 2 modes are currently supported :
2045 - path-parameters :
2046 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2047 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2048 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2049 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2050 - query-string :
2051 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2052 query string.
2053
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002054 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2055 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2056 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002058 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2059 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060
2061
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002062backlog <conns>
2063 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2065 yes | yes | yes | no
2066 Arguments :
2067 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2068 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002069 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002070
2071 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2072 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2073 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2074 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2075 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2076 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2077 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2078 backlog parameter.
2079
2080 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2081 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2082 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2083
2084 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2085
2086
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002087balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002088balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002089 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2091 yes | no | yes | yes
2092 Arguments :
2093 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2094 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2095 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2096 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2097
2098 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2099 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2100 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2101 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002102 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002103 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002104 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2105 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2106 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2107 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2108 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2109 it, so that you don't worry.
2110
2111 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2112 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2113 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2114 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2115 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2116 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2117 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2118 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002119
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002120 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2121 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2122 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2123 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2124 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2125 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2126 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2127 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2128
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002129 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002130 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002131 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2132 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002133 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002134 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2135 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2136 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2137 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2138 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002139 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2140 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2141 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2142 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2143 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2144 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002145
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002146 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2147 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2148 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2149 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2150 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2151 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2152 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2153 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002154 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002155 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002156 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2157 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2158 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002159
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002160 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2161 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2162 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2163 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2164 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2165 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2166 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2167 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2168 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2169 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2170 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2171 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002172
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002173 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002174 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2175 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2176 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2177 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2178 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2179 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2180 URIs start with a leading "/".
2181
2182 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2183 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2184 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2185 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2186
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002187 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002188 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2189
2190 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002191 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2192 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002193 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2194 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2195 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2196 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002197 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002198 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2199 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002200
2201 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2202 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2203 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2204 server will receive the request.
2205
2206 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2207 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2208 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2209 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2210 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002211 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2212 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2213 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002214
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002215 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2216 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2217 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2218 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2219 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002221 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002222 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2223 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2224 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2225
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002226 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2227 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2228 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2229
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002230 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002231 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002232 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2233 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2234 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2235 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2236 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2237 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002238 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002239 used instead.
2240
2241 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2242 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2243 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2244 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2245
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002246 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2247 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2248 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2249
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002250 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002251
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002252 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002253 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2254 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002255
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002256 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2257 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2258 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002259
2260 Examples :
2261 balance roundrobin
2262 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002263 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002264 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2265 balance hdr(host)
2266 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002267
2268 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2269 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002271 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002272 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2273 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2274 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2275 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2276
2277 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2278 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2279 defaults to 16 kB.
2280
2281 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2282 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2283
2284 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2285 Round Robin.
2286
2287 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2288 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2289 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2290 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2291
2292 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2293
2294 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002295 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002296 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2297 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2298 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002299
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002300 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002301
2302
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002303bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2304bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002305 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2307 no | yes | yes | no
2308 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002309 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2310 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2311 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2312 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002313 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002314 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2315 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2316 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2317 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2318 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2319 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2320 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002321 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2322 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2323 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2324 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2325 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2326 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2327 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002328 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2329 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2330 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002331 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2332 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2333 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002334
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002335 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2336 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002337 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2338 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2339 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002340 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2341 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2342 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2343 the range.
2344
2345 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2346 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2347 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2348 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2349 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2350 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2351 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002352 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002353 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002354
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002355 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2356 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2357 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2358 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2359 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2360 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2361 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2362 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2363
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002364 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2365 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2366 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2367 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2370 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2371 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2372 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2373 in a frontend.
2374
2375 Example :
2376 listen http_proxy
2377 bind :80,:443
2378 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002379 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002380
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002381 listen http_https_proxy
2382 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002383 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002384
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002385 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2386 bind ipv6@:80
2387 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2388 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2389
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002390 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002391 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002392
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002393 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2394 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2395 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2396 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2397 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2398
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002399 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002400 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002401
2402
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002403bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002404 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2406 yes | yes | yes | yes
2407 Arguments :
2408 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2409 may be used to override a default value.
2410
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002411 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002412 option may be combined with other numbers.
2413
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002414 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002415 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2416 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2417 missing from all processes.
2418
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002419 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002420 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002421 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2422 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2423 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2424 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002425
2426 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2427 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2428 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2429 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2430 and 'even' instances.
2431
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002432 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2433 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2434 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2435 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002436
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002437 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2438 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2439
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002440 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2441 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2442 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2443
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002444 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2445 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2446
2447 Example :
2448 listen app_ip1
2449 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002450 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002451
2452 listen app_ip2
2453 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002454 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002455
2456 listen management
2457 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002458 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002459
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002460 listen management
2461 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2462 bind-process 1-4
2463
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002464 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002465
2466
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002467block { if | unless } <condition>
2468 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2470 no | yes | yes | yes
2471
2472 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2473 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002474 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002475 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002476 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2477 "block" statements per instance.
2478
2479 Example:
2480 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2481 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2482 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2483 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002485 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002486
2487
2488capture cookie <name> len <length>
2489 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2491 no | yes | yes | no
2492 Arguments :
2493 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2494 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2495 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2496 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2497 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2498
2499 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2500 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2501 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2502 right if it exceeds <length>.
2503
2504 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2505 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2506 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2507 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2508
2509 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2510 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2511 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2512
2513 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2514 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2515 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002516 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2517 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2518 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002519
2520 Example:
2521 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2522
2523 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002524 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002525
2526
2527capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002528 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2530 no | yes | yes | no
2531 Arguments :
2532 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002533 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002534 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2535 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2536 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2537
2538 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2539 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2540 it exceeds <length>.
2541
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002542 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002543 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2544 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002545 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2546 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2547 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2548 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002549 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002550 environments to find where the request came from.
2551
2552 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2553 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2554 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2555 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002556
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002557 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2558 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2559 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2560 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2561 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002562
2563 Example:
2564 capture request header Host len 15
2565 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002566 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002568 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569 about logging.
2570
2571
2572capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002573 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2575 no | yes | yes | no
2576 Arguments :
2577 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002578 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002579 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2580 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2581 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2582
2583 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2584 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2585 it exceeds <length>.
2586
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002587 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002588 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2589 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2590 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002591 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2592 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2593 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2594 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002595
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002596 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2597 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2598 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2599 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2600 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002601
2602 Example:
2603 capture response header Content-length len 9
2604 capture response header Location len 15
2605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002606 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607 about logging.
2608
2609
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002610clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002611 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2613 yes | yes | yes | no
2614 Arguments :
2615 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2616 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2617 as explained at the top of this document.
2618
2619 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2620 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2621 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2622 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2623 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2624 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2625 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2626 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002627 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002628 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2629 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2630
2631 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2632 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2633 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2634 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2635 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2636 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2637
2638 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2639 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2640
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002641 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2642 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002643
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002644compression algo <algorithm> ...
2645compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002646compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002647 Enable HTTP compression.
2648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2649 yes | yes | yes | yes
2650 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002651 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2652 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2653 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2654
2655 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002656 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2657 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2658 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002659
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002660 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002661 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002662
2663 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2664 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2665 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2666 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2667 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002668 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002669
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002670 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2671 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2672 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2673 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2674 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2675 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2676 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002677 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002678
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002679 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002680 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002681 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2682 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2683 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2684 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2685 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002686
2687 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2688 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2689 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2690 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2691 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002692 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2693 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2694 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2695 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2696 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002697 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2698 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002699
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002700 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002701 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2702 "Accept-Encoding" header
2703 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002704 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002705 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2706 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002707 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2708 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2709 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2710 "multipart"
2711 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2712 header
2713 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2714 and later
2715 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2716 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002717
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002718 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2719 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002720
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002721 Examples :
2722 compression algo gzip
2723 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002724
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002725
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002726contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002727 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2729 yes | no | yes | yes
2730 Arguments :
2731 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2732 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2733 as explained at the top of this document.
2734
2735 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002736 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002737 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002738 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2739 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2740 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2741 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2742
2743 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2744 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2745 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2746 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2747 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2748 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2749
2750 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2751 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2752 instead.
2753
2754 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2755 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2756
2757
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002758cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002759 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2760 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2763 yes | no | yes | yes
2764 Arguments :
2765 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2766 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2767 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2768 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2769 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2770 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2771 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2772 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2773 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2774
2775 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2776 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2777 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2778 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2779 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2780 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002781 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2782 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2783 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2784 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2785 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002786
2787 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002788 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002789
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002790 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002791 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2792 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2793 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2794 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2795 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2796 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2797 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2798 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2799 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2800 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002801
2802 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2803 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2804 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2805 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2806 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2807 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2808 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2809 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2810 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002811 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002812 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2813 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2814 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002815
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002816 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2817 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2818 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002819 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2820 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2821 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2822 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002823 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2824 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2825 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002826
2827 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2828 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2829 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2830 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2831 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2832 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2833 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2834 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2835 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2836
2837 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2838 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2839 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2840 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2841 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2842 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2843 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2844 persistence cookie in the cache.
2845 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2846
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002847 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2848 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2849 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2850 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2851 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2852 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2853 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2854 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2855 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2856 they logout.
2857
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002858 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2859 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2860 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2861 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2862
2863 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2864 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2865 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2866 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2867 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2868 this attribute.
2869
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002870 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002871 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002872 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2873 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2874 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2875 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2876 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2877 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002878
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002879 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2880 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2881 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2882 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2883 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2884 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2885 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2886 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2887 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2888 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2889 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2890 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2891 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2892 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2893 the site.
2894
2895 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2896 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2897 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2898 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2899 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2900 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2901 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2902 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2903 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2904 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2905 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2906 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2907 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2908 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2909 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2910 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2911
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2913 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2914 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2915 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002916
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917 Examples :
2918 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2919 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2920 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002921 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002922
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002923 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002924
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002925
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002926declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2927 Declares a capture slot.
2928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2929 no | yes | yes | no
2930 Arguments:
2931 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2932
2933 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2934 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2935 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2936 for use in the response.
2937
2938 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002939 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002940 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2941
2942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002943default-server [param*]
2944 Change default options for a server in a backend
2945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2946 yes | no | yes | yes
2947 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002948 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2949 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2950 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2951 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002952
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002953 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002954 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2955
2956 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002957
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002958
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002959default_backend <backend>
2960 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2962 yes | yes | yes | no
2963 Arguments :
2964 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2965
2966 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2967 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2968 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2969 will catch all undetermined requests.
2970
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002971 Example :
2972
2973 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2974 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2975 default_backend dynamic
2976
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002977 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002978
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002979
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002980description <string>
2981 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2983 no | yes | yes | yes
2984 Arguments : string
2985
2986 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2987 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2988 it describes.
2989 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2990
2991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002992disabled
2993 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2995 yes | yes | yes | yes
2996 Arguments : none
2997
2998 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2999 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3000 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3001 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3002 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3003 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3004 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3005
3006 See also : "enabled"
3007
3008
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003009dispatch <address>:<port>
3010 Set a default server address
3011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3012 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003013 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003014
3015 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3016 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3017 during start-up.
3018
3019 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3020 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3021 possible with normal servers.
3022
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003023 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003024 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3025 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3026 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3027 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3028
3029 See also : "server"
3030
3031
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003032enabled
3033 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3035 yes | yes | yes | yes
3036 Arguments : none
3037
3038 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3039 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3040
3041 See also : "disabled"
3042
3043
3044errorfile <code> <file>
3045 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3047 yes | yes | yes | yes
3048 Arguments :
3049 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04003050 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3051 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003052
3053 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003054 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003055 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003056 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3057 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003058
3059 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3060 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3061 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3062
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003063 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3064
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003065 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3066 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3067 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3068 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3069
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003070 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3071 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3072 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3073 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3074 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3075 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3076
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3078 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3079 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003080 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003081 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3082
3083 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3084
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003085 Example :
3086 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003087 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003088 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3089 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3090
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003091
3092errorloc <code> <url>
3093errorloc302 <code> <url>
3094 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3096 yes | yes | yes | yes
3097 Arguments :
3098 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003099 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003100
3101 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3102 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3103 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3104 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3105 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3106
3107 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3108 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3109 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3110
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003111 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3112
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003113 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3114 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3115 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3116 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003117 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003118 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3119 request.
3120
3121 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3122
3123
3124errorloc303 <code> <url>
3125 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3127 yes | yes | yes | yes
3128 Arguments :
3129 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3130 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3131
3132 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3133 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3134 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3135 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3136 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3137
3138 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3139 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3140 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3141
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003142 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3143
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003144 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3145 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3146 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3147 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003148 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003149
3150 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3151
3152
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003153email-alert from <emailaddr>
3154 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3155 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3156 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3157 yes | yes | yes | yes
3158
3159 Arguments :
3160
3161 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3162
3163 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3164 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3165
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003166 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003167 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3168 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003169
3170
3171email-alert level <level>
3172 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3173 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3174 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3175 yes | yes | yes | yes
3176
3177 Arguments :
3178
3179 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3180 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3181 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3182
3183 By default level is alert
3184
3185 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3186 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3187 for the proxy.
3188
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003189 Alerts are sent when :
3190
3191 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3192 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3193 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3194 is notice or lower
3195 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3196 and a health check status update occurs
3197
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003198 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3199 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003200 section 3.6 about mailers.
3201
3202
3203email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3204 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3205 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3206 yes | yes | yes | yes
3207
3208 Arguments :
3209
3210 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3211
3212 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3213 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3214
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003215 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3216 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003217
3218
3219email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3220 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3221 mailers.
3222 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3223 yes | yes | yes | yes
3224
3225 Arguments :
3226
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003227 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003228
3229 By default the systems hostname is used.
3230
3231 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3232 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3233 for the proxy.
3234
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003235 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3236 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003237
3238
3239email-alert to <emailaddr>
3240 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3241 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3242 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3243 yes | yes | yes | yes
3244
3245 Arguments :
3246
3247 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3248
3249 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3250 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3251
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003252 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003253 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3254
3255
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003256force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3257 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3258 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3259 no | yes | yes | yes
3260
3261 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3262 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3263 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3264 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3265 marked down for maintenance operations.
3266
3267 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3268 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3269 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3270 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3271 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3272 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3273 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3274 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3275 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3276
3277 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3278 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3279 is used.
3280
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003281 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003282 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003283
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003284
3285filter <name> [param*]
3286 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3288 no | yes | yes | yes
3289 Arguments :
3290 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3291 referenced in section 9.
3292
3293 <param*> is a list of parameters accpeted by the filter <name>. The
3294 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
3295 filter. Please refer to the documention of the corresponding
3296 filter (section 9) from all details on the supported parameters.
3297
3298 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3299 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3300
3301 Example:
3302 listen
3303 bind *:80
3304
3305 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3306 filter compression
3307 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3308
3309 compression algo gzip
3310 compression offload
3311
3312 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3313
3314 See also : section 9.
3315
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003316
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003317fullconn <conns>
3318 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3320 yes | no | yes | yes
3321 Arguments :
3322 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3323 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3324
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003325 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003326 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003327 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003328 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3329 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3330 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3331 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3332 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003333 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003334
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003335 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3336 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003337 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3338 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3339 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003340
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003341 Example :
3342 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3343 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3344 # connections.
3345 backend dynamic
3346 fullconn 10000
3347 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3348 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3349
3350 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3351
3352
3353grace <time>
3354 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003356 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003357 Arguments :
3358 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3359 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3360 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3361
3362 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3363 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003364 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003365 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3366
3367 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3368 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3369 simplify it.
3370
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003371
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003372hash-balance-factor <factor>
3373 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3375 yes | no | no | yes
3376 Arguments :
3377 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3378 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3379 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3380
3381 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3382 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3383 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3384 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3385 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3386 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3387 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3388
3389 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3390 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3391 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3392 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3393 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3394
3395 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3396
3397
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003398hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003399 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3401 yes | no | yes | yes
3402 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003403 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3404 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003405
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003406 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3407 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3408 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3409 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3410 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3411 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3412 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3413 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3414 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3415 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003416
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003417 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3418 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3419 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3420 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3421 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3422 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3423 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3424 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3425 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3426 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3427 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3428 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3429 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003430 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3431 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003432
3433 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3434
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003435 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003436 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3437 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3438 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003439 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3440 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3441 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003442
3443 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3444 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003445 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3446 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3447 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3448 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3449
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003450 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3451 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3452 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3453 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3454 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3455 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3456 parameter.
3457
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003458 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3459 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3460 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3461 used on strings.
3462
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003463 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3464
3465 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3466 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3467 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3468 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3469 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3470 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3471 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3472 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3473 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3474 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3475 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3476 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003477
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003478 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3479 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3480 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003481
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003482 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003483
3484
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003485http-check disable-on-404
3486 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003488 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003489 Arguments : none
3490
3491 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3492 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3493 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3494 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3495 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3496 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3497 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3498 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003499 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3500 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3501 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3502
3503 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3504
3505
3506http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003507 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003509 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003510 Arguments :
3511 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3512 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003513 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003514 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3515 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3516 details on the supported keywords.
3517
3518 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3519 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3520 with the usual backslash ('\').
3521
3522 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3523 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3524 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3525 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3526 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3527
3528 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003529 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003530 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3531 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3532 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3533
3534 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003535 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003536 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3537 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3538 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3539 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3540
3541 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003542 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003543 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3544 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3545 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3546 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3547 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3548 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3549 trace).
3550
3551 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003552 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003553 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3554 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3555 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3556 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3557 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3558 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3559
3560 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3561 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3562 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3563 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3564 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3565 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3566 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3567 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3568
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003569 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3570 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3571 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3572
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003573 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3574 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3575
3576 Examples :
3577 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003578 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003579
3580 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003581 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003582
3583 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003584 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003585
3586 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003587 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003588
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003589 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003590
3591
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003592http-check send-state
3593 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3595 yes | no | yes | yes
3596 Arguments : none
3597
3598 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3599 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3600 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3601 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3602 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3603
3604 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3605 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3606 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3607 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3608 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003609 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3610 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3611 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3612
3613 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3614 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3615 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3616
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003617 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3618 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3619 checked in multiple backends.
3620
3621 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3622 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3623
3624 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3625 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3626 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3627 one fails.
3628
3629 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3630 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3631 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3632
3633 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3634 server's queue.
3635
3636 Example of a header received by the application server :
3637 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3638 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3639
3640 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3641
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003642http-request { allow | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3643 deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003644 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003645 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003646 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003647 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3648 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003649 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3650 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003651 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3652 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3653 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003654 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003655 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003656 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003657 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003658 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003659 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003660 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003661 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003662 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3663
3664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3665 no | yes | yes | yes
3666
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003667 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3668 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3669 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3670 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3671 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003672
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003673 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3674 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3675 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3676
3677 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003678 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3679 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3680 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3681 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003682
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003683 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3684 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3685 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3686 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3687 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3688 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3689 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3690 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3691 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003692 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003693 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3694 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003695
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003696 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3697 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3698 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3699 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3700 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3701
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003702 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3703 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3704 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003705 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3706 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003707
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003708 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3709 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3710 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3711 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3712 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3713 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3714 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3715 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3716
3717 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3718 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3719 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003720 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3721 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003722
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003723 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3724 <name>.
3725
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003726 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3727 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3728 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3729 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3730 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3731 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3732 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3733 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3734
3735 Example:
3736
3737 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3738
3739 applied to:
3740
3741 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3742
3743 outputs:
3744
3745 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3746
3747 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3748
3749 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3750 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3751 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3752 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3753 header.
3754
3755 Example:
3756
3757 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3758
3759 applied to:
3760
3761 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3762
3763 outputs:
3764
3765 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3766
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003767 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3768 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3769 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3770 it.
3771
3772 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3773 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3774 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3775 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3776 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3777 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3778
3779 Example :
3780 # prepend the host name before the path
3781 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3782
3783 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3784 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3785 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3786 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3787 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3788 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3789 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3790 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3791
3792 Example :
3793 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3794 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3795
3796 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3797 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3798 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3799 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3800 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3801 "set-query".
3802
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003803 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3804 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3805 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3806 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3807 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3808 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3809 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3810 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3811
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003812 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3813 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3814 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3815 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3816 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3817 another equipment.
3818
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003819 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3820 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3821 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3822 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3823 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3824 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3825 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3826 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3827
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003828 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3829 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3830 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3831 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3832 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3833 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3834 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3835 admin privileges.
3836
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003837 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3838 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3839 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3840 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3841 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3842 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3843 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3844 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3845
3846 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3847 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3848 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3849 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3850 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3851 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3852
3853 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3854 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3855 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3856 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3857 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3858 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3859
3860 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3861 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3862 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3863 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3864 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3865 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3866 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3867 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3868 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3869
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003870 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003871 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3872 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3873 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3874 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3875 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3876 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3877 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3878 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3879 request header" for more information.
3880
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003881 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3882 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3883 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3884 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003885 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3886 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003887
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003888 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3889 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3890 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3891 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3892 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3893 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3894 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3895 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3896 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3897 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3898 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3899 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3900
3901 These actions take one or two arguments :
3902 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3903 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3904 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3905 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3906
3907 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3908 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3909 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3910 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3911
3912 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3913 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3914 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3915 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3916 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3917 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3918 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3919 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3920
3921 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3922 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3923 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3924 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3925 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3926
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003927 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3928 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3929 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3930 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3931 continues.
3932
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003933 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3934 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3935 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3936 the actions evaluation continues.
3937
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003938 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3939 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3940 inline.
3941
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003942 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3943 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
3944 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3945 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003946 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003947 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003948 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003949 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
3950 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003951 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003952 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003953 and '_'.
3954
3955 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3956 followed by some converters.
3957
3958 Example:
3959
3960 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3961
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003962 - set-src <expr> :
3963 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3964 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3965 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3966 source IP for privacy.
3967
3968 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3969 followed by some converters.
3970
3971 Example:
3972
3973 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3974 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3975
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003976 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
3977 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003978
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003979 - set-src-port <expr> :
3980 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
3981 expression.
3982
3983 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3984 followed by some converters.
3985
3986 Example:
3987
3988 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
3989 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
3990
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003991 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
3992 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
3993 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003994
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02003995 - set-dst <expr> :
3996 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
3997 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
3998 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3999 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4000 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4001
4002 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4003 followed by some converters.
4004
4005 Example:
4006
4007 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4008 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4009
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004010 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4011 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4012
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004013 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4014 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4015 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4016 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4017
4018 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4019 followed by some converters.
4020
4021 Example:
4022
4023 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4024 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4025
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004026 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4027 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4028 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4029
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004030 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4031 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4032 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4033 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4034 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4035 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4036 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4037 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4038 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4039 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4040 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4041 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4042 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4043 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4044 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4045 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4046
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004047 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4048
4049 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4050 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004051 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4052 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4053
4054 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4055 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4056 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4057 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004058
4059 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004060 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4061 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4062 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004063
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004064 http-request allow if nagios
4065 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4066 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4067 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004068
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004069 Example:
4070 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004071 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004072
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004073 Example:
4074 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4075 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004076 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004077 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4078 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4079 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4080 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4081 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4082 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4083
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004084 Example:
4085 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4086 acl add path /addacl
4087 acl del path /delacl
4088
4089 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4090
4091 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4092 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4093
4094 Example:
4095 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4096 acl setmap path /setmap
4097 acl delmap path /delmap
4098
4099 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4100
4101 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4102 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4103
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004104 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4105 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004106
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004107http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004108 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004109 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004110 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4111 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004112 set-status <status> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004113 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4114 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4115 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4116 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004117 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004118 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004119 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004120 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004121 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004122 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004123 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004124 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004125 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4126
4127 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4128 no | yes | yes | yes
4129
4130 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4131 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4132 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4133 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4134 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4135 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4136
4137 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4138 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4139 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4140 current section.
4141
4142 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4143 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4144 rules are evaluated.
4145
4146 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4147 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4148 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4149 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4150 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4151 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4152 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4153
4154 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4155 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4156 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4157 external users.
4158
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004159 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4160 <name>.
4161
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004162 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4163 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4164 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4165 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4166 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4167 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4168 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4169 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4170
4171 Example:
4172
4173 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4174
4175 applied to:
4176
4177 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4178
4179 outputs:
4180
4181 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4182
4183 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4184
4185 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4186 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4187 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4188 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4189 header.
4190
4191 Example:
4192
4193 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4194
4195 applied to:
4196
4197 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4198
4199 outputs:
4200
4201 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4202
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004203 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
4204 be an integer between 100 and 999. Note that the reason is automatically
4205 adapted to the new code.
4206
4207 Example:
4208
4209 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4210 http-response set-status 431
4211
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004212 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4213 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4214 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4215 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4216 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4217 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4218 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4219 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4220
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004221 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4222 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4223 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4224 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4225 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4226 another equipment.
4227
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004228 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4229 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4230 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4231 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4232 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4233 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4234 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4235 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4236
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004237 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4238 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4239 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4240 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4241 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4242 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4243 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4244 admin privileges.
4245
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004246 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4247 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4248 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4249 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4250 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4251 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4252 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4253 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4254
4255 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4256 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4257 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4258 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4259 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4260 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4261
4262 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4263 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4264 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4265 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4266 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4267 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4268
4269 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4270 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4271 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4272 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4273 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4274 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4275 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4276 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4277 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4278
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004279 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4280 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4281 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4282 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4283 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4284 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4285 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4286 response header" for more information.
4287
4288 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4289 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4290 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4291 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4292 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004293 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4294 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004295
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004296 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4297 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4298 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4299 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4300 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4301 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4302
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004303 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4304 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4305 inline.
4306
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004307 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4308 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
4309 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4310 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004311 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004312 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004313 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004314 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4315 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004316 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004317 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004318 and '_'.
4319
4320 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4321 followed by some converters.
4322
4323 Example:
4324
4325 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4326
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004327 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4328 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4329 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4330 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4331 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4332 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4333 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4334
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004335 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4336 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4337 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4338 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4339 continues.
4340
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004341 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4342 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4343 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4344 the actions evaluation continues.
4345
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004346 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4347 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4348 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4349 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4350 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4351 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4352 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4353 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4354 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4355 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4356 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4357 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4358 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4359 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4360 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4361 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4362
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004363 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4364
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004365 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004366 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4367 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004368 rules.
4369
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004370 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4371 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4372 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4373 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4374
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004375 Example:
4376 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4377
4378 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4379
4380 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4381 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4382
4383 Example:
4384 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4385
4386 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4387
4388 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4389 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4390
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004391 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4392 ACL usage.
4393
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004394
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004395http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4396 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4397
4398 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4399 yes | no | yes | yes
4400
4401 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4402 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4403 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4404 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4405 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4406 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4407
4408 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4409
4410 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4411 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4412 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4413 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4414 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4415 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4416 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4417 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4418 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4419 not checking any request past the first one.
4420
4421 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4422 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4423 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4424 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4425 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4426 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4427 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4428
4429 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4430 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4431 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4432 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4433 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4434 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4435 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4436 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4437 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4438 downsides of rare connection failures.
4439
4440 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4441 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4442 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4443 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4444 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4445 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4446 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4447 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4448 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4449 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4450 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4451 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4452
4453 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4454 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4455 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4456 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4457
4458 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4459 and are never shared ;
4460
4461 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4462 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4463 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4464 and are never shared ;
4465
4466 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4467 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4468 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4469
4470 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4471 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4472 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4473
4474 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4475
4476
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004477http-send-name-header [<header>]
4478 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4479
4480 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4481 yes | no | yes | yes
4482
4483 Arguments :
4484
4485 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4486
4487 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4488 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4489 is added with the header string proved.
4490
4491 See also : "server"
4492
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004493id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004494 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4496 no | yes | yes | yes
4497 Arguments : none
4498
4499 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4500 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4501 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004502
4503
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004504ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4505 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4506 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4507 no | yes | yes | yes
4508
4509 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4510 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4511 and running).
4512
4513 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4514 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4515 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004516 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004517 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4518
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004519 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4520 "unless" condition is met.
4521
4522 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4523
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004524load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4525 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4526 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4527 yes | no | yes | yes
4528
4529 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4530 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4531 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4532 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4533 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4534 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4535 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4536 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4537
4538 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4539 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004540 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004541
4542 Arguments:
4543 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4544 named "server-state-file".
4545
4546 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4547 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4548 name is used as a file name.
4549
4550 none don't load any stat for this backend
4551
4552 Notes:
4553 - server's IP address is not updated unless DNS resolution is enabled on
4554 the server. It means that if a server IP address has been changed using
4555 the stat socket, this information won't be re-applied after reloading.
4556
4557 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4558 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4559
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004560 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004561
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004562 global
4563 stats socket /tmp/socket
4564 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004565
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004566 defaults
4567 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004568
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004569 backend bk
4570 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4571 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004572
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004573
4574 Then one can run :
4575
4576 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4577
4578 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4579
4580 1
4581 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4582 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4583 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4584
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004585 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004586
4587 global
4588 stats socket /tmp/socket
4589 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4590
4591 defaults
4592 load-server-state-from-file local
4593
4594 backend bk
4595 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4596 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4597
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004598
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004599 Then one can run :
4600
4601 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4602
4603 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4604
4605 1
4606 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4607 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4608 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4609
4610 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4611 "show servers state"
4612
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004613
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004614log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004615log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004616no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004617 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4619 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004620
4621 Prefix :
4622 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4623 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4624 prefix does not allow arguments.
4625
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004626 Arguments :
4627 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4628 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4629 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4630 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4631 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4632 parameter.
4633
4634 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4635 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4636
4637 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4638 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4639 standard syslog port).
4640
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004641 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4642 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4643 standard syslog port).
4644
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004645 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4646 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4647 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4648 appropriately writeable).
4649
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004650 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4651 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004652
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004653 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4654 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4655 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4656 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4657 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4658 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4659 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4660 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4661 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4662 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4663 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4664
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004665 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4666
4667 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4668 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4669 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4670
4671 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4672 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4673 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004674 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4675 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4676 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4677 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4678 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004679
4680 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4681
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004682 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4683 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4684 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004685
4686 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4687 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4688 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4689 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4690
4691 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4692 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004693
4694 Example :
4695 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004696 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4697 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004698 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004699
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004700
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004701log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004702 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4703 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4704 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004705
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004706 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4707 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4708 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4709 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4710 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004711
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004712log-format-sd <string>
4713 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4714 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4715 yes | yes | yes | no
4716
4717 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4718 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4719 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4720 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4721 which covers the log format string in depth.
4722
4723 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4724 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4725
4726 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4727 log format to "rfc5424".
4728
4729 Example :
4730 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4731
4732
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004733log-tag <string>
4734 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4735 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4736 yes | yes | yes | yes
4737
4738 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4739 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4740 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4741 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4742 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4743 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4744 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4745 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4746 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004747
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004748max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4749 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4750 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4751 yes | no | yes | yes
4752
4753 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4754 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4755 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4756 servers.
4757
4758 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4759 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4760 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4761 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4762 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4763 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4764 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4765 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4766 picking a different server.
4767
4768 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4769 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4770 even if they have to be queued.
4771
4772 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4773 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4774
4775
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004776maxconn <conns>
4777 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4779 yes | yes | yes | no
4780 Arguments :
4781 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4782 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4783 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4784 closes.
4785
4786 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4787 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4788 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4789 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004790 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4791 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4792 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4793 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004794
4795 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4796 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4797 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4798
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004799 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4800
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004801 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4802
4803
4804mode { tcp|http|health }
4805 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4807 yes | yes | yes | yes
4808 Arguments :
4809 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4810 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4811 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4812 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4813
4814 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4815 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4816 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4817 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4818 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4819
4820 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004821 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4822 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4823 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4824 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4825 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4826 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4827 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004828
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004829 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4830 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4831 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004832
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004833 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004834 defaults http_instances
4835 mode http
4836
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004837 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004838
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004839
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004840monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004841 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4843 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004844 Arguments :
4845 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4846 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004847 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004848 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4849 backend and its backup.
4850
4851 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4852 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4853 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4854 servers in a list of backends.
4855
4856 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4857 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4858 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4859 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4860 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4861 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4862 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004863 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4864 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004865
4866 Example:
4867 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004868 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004869 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4870 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4871 monitor-uri /site_alive
4872 monitor fail if site_dead
4873
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004874 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004875
4876
4877monitor-net <source>
4878 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4880 yes | yes | yes | no
4881 Arguments :
4882 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4883 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4884 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4885 followed by a mask.
4886
4887 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4888 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004889 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004890 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4891
4892 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4893 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4894 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4895 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004896 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4897 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4898 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004899
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004900 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4901 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4902 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4903 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4904 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4905 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004906
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004907 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4908 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004909
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004910 Example :
4911 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4912 frontend www
4913 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4914
4915 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4916
4917
4918monitor-uri <uri>
4919 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4921 yes | yes | yes | no
4922 Arguments :
4923 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4924 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4925
4926 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4927 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4928 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4929 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4930 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4931 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4932 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4933 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4934
4935 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4936 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4937 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4938 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4939 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4940 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4941
4942 Example :
4943 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4944 frontend www
4945 mode http
4946 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4947
4948 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4949
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004950
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004951option abortonclose
4952no option abortonclose
4953 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4955 yes | no | yes | yes
4956 Arguments : none
4957
4958 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4959 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4960 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4961 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004962 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004963 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4964 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4965 encountered while delivering the response.
4966
4967 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4968 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4969 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4970 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4971 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4972 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004973 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004974 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004975 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004976 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4977 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4978 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4979
4980 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4981 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4982 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4983 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4984 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4985 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4986 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4987 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004988 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004989
4990 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4991 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4992
4993 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4994
4995
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004996option accept-invalid-http-request
4997no option accept-invalid-http-request
4998 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5000 yes | yes | yes | no
5001 Arguments : none
5002
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005003 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005004 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5005 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5006 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5007 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5008 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5009 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5010 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005011 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5012 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5013 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5014 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5015 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005016 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005017 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5018 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5019 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005020
5021 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5022 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5023 been confirmed.
5024
5025 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5026 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005027 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5028 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005029 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5030
5031 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5032 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5033
5034 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5035 stats socket.
5036
5037
5038option accept-invalid-http-response
5039no option accept-invalid-http-response
5040 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5042 yes | no | yes | yes
5043 Arguments : none
5044
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005045 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005046 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5047 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5048 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5049 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5050 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5051 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5052 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005053 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5054 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5055 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005056
5057 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5058 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5059 been confirmed.
5060
5061 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5062 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5063 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5064 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5065
5066 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5067 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5068
5069 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5070 stats socket.
5071
5072
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005073option allbackups
5074no option allbackups
5075 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5077 yes | no | yes | yes
5078 Arguments : none
5079
5080 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5081 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5082 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5083 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5084 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5085 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5086 order between the backup servers anymore.
5087
5088 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5089 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5090
5091 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5092 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5093
5094
5095option checkcache
5096no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005097 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5099 yes | no | yes | yes
5100 Arguments : none
5101
5102 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5103 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005104 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005105 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5106 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005107 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005108
5109 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005110 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005111 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005112 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5113 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005114 to the client are :
5115 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005116 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005117 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005118 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5119 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5120 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5121 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5122 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5123 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5124 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5125 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5126 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5127 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5128 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5129
5130 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005131 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005132 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005133 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005134 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5135
5136 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5137 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005138 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005139 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5140
5141 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5142 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5143
5144
5145option clitcpka
5146no option clitcpka
5147 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5149 yes | yes | yes | no
5150 Arguments : none
5151
5152 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5153 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5154 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5155 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5156
5157 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5158 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5159 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5160 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5161
5162 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5163 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5164 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5165 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5166 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5167
5168 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5169
5170 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5171 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5172 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5173
5174 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5175 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5176
5177 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5178
5179
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005180option contstats
5181 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5183 yes | yes | yes | no
5184 Arguments : none
5185
5186 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5187 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5188 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5189 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
5190 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
5191 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
5192 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
5193
5194
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005195option dontlog-normal
5196no option dontlog-normal
5197 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5199 yes | yes | yes | no
5200 Arguments : none
5201
5202 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5203 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5204 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5205 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5206 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5207 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5208 logged.
5209
5210 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5211 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5212 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005214 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005215 logging.
5216
5217
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005218option dontlognull
5219no option dontlognull
5220 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5222 yes | yes | yes | no
5223 Arguments : none
5224
5225 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5226 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5227 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5228 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5229 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5230 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005231 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5232 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5233 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005234
5235 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5236 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5237 would not be logged.
5238
5239 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5240 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5241
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005242 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5243 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005244
5245
5246option forceclose
5247no option forceclose
5248 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005250 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005251 Arguments : none
5252
5253 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5254 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5255 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5256 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5257 global session times in the logs.
5258
5259 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005260 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005261 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005262
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005263 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5264 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5265 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5266
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005267 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5268 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005269
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005270 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5271 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5272
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005273 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005274
5275
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005276option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005277 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5279 yes | yes | yes | yes
5280 Arguments :
5281 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5282 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005283 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005284 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005285
5286 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5287 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5288 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5289 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5290 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5291 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5292 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005293 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5294 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5295 possible that the client has already brought one.
5296
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005297 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005298 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005299 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5300 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005301 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5302 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005303
5304 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5305 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5306 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5307 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5308 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5309 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5310 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5311
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005312 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5313 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5314 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5315 are under the control of the end-user.
5316
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005317 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005318 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5319 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005320 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5321 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5322 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005323
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005324 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005325 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5326 frontend www
5327 mode http
5328 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5329
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005330 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5331 backend www
5332 mode http
5333 option forwardfor header X-Client
5334
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005335 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005336 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005337
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005338
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005339option http-buffer-request
5340no option http-buffer-request
5341 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5343 yes | yes | yes | yes
5344 Arguments : none
5345
5346 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5347 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5348 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5349 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5350 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5351 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5352 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5353 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
5354 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
5355 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5356 default.
5357
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005358 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005359
5360
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005361option http-ignore-probes
5362no option http-ignore-probes
5363 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5365 yes | yes | yes | no
5366 Arguments : none
5367
5368 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5369 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5370 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5371 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5372 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5373 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5374 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5375 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5376 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5377 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5378 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5379 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5380
5381 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5382 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5383 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5384 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5385 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5386 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5387 are often the only way to detect them.
5388
5389 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5390 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5391
5392 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5393
5394
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005395option http-keep-alive
5396no option http-keep-alive
5397 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5399 yes | yes | yes | yes
5400 Arguments : none
5401
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005402 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5403 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5404 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5405 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5406 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5407 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5408 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5409
5410 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5411 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005412 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5413 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5414 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5415 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5416 situations where this option may be useful :
5417
5418 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5419 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5420
5421 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5422 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5423
5424 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5425 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5426 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5427 request.
5428
5429 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5430 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005431 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5432 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5433 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005434
5435 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5436 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5437
5438 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5439 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5440 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5441 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5442 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5443 not set.
5444
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005445 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5446 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005447 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005448 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005449
5450 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005451 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5452 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005453
5454
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005455option http-no-delay
5456no option http-no-delay
5457 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5459 yes | yes | yes | yes
5460 Arguments : none
5461
5462 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5463 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5464 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5465 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5466 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5467 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5468 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5469 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5470 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5471 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5472 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5473 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5474 affected.
5475
5476 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5477 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5478 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5479 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5480 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5481 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5482 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5483 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5484 latency environments.
5485
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005486 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5487
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005488
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005489option http-pretend-keepalive
5490no option http-pretend-keepalive
5491 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5493 yes | yes | yes | yes
5494 Arguments : none
5495
5496 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5497 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5498 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5499 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5500 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5501 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5502 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5503 consider the response complete.
5504
5505 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5506 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5507 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5508 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5509 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5510 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5511
5512 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5513 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5514 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5515 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5516 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5517 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5518 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5519
5520 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5521 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005522 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005523 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5524 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005525
5526 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5527 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5528
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005529 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5530 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005531
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005532
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005533option http-server-close
5534no option http-server-close
5535 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5537 yes | yes | yes | yes
5538 Arguments : none
5539
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005540 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5541 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5542 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5543 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5544 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5545 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5546 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5547 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5548 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5549 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5550 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5551 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5552 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5553 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5554 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5555 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005556
5557 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5558 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5559 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5560 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005561 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5562 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005563
5564 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5565 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005566 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5567 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005568 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5569 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005570
5571 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5572 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5573
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005574 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005575 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5576 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005577
5578
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005579option http-tunnel
5580no option http-tunnel
5581 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5583 yes | yes | yes | yes
5584 Arguments : none
5585
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005586 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5587 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5588 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5589 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5590 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5591 "option http-tunnel".
5592
5593 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005594 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005595 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5596 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5597 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5598 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5599 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5600 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5601 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005602
5603 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5604 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5605
5606 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5607 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5608 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5609
5610
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005611option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005612no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005613 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5615 yes | yes | yes | no
5616 Arguments : none
5617
5618 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5619 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5620 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5621 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5622 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5623 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5624 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5625
5626 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5627 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005628 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5629 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5630 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005631
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005632 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5633 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5634 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5635 front of an existing proxy.
5636
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005637 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5638
5639 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5640 http-server-close".
5641
5642
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005643option httpchk
5644option httpchk <uri>
5645option httpchk <method> <uri>
5646option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5647 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5649 yes | no | yes | yes
5650 Arguments :
5651 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5652 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5653 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5654 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5655 ones.
5656
5657 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5658 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5659 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5660
5661 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5662 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5663 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5664 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5665 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5666
5667 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5668 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5669 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5670 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5671 the lack of any response.
5672
5673 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5674
5675 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5676 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5677 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5678
5679 Examples :
5680 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5681 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5682 backend https_relay
5683 mode tcp
5684 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5685 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5686
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005687 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5688 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5689 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005690
5691
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005692option httpclose
5693no option httpclose
5694 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5696 yes | yes | yes | yes
5697 Arguments : none
5698
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005699 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5700 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5701 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5702 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005703 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005704 "option http-tunnel".
5705
5706 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5707 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5708 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5709 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5710 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5711 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5712 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5713 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005714
5715 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005716 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005717 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5718 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5719 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5720 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5721 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005722
5723 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5724 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005725 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5726 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005727 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5728 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005729
5730 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5731 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5732
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005733 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5734 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005735
5736
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005737option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005738 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5740 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005741 Arguments :
5742 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5743 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5744 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5745 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5746 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005747
5748 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5749 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5750 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5751 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5752 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5753 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5754 ports.
5755
5756 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5757
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005758 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5759 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005761 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005762
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005763
5764option http_proxy
5765no option http_proxy
5766 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5768 yes | yes | yes | yes
5769 Arguments : none
5770
5771 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5772 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5773 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5774 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5775 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5776
5777 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5778 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005779 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5780 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005781
5782 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5783 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5784
5785 Example :
5786 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5787 backend direct_forward
5788 option httpclose
5789 option http_proxy
5790
5791 See also : "option httpclose"
5792
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005793
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005794option independent-streams
5795no option independent-streams
5796 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5798 yes | yes | yes | yes
5799 Arguments : none
5800
5801 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5802 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5803 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5804 receive data or not.
5805
5806 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5807 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5808 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5809 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5810 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5811 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5812 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5813 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5814 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5815 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5816 socket buffers.
5817
5818 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5819 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5820 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5821 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5822 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5823
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005824 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005825 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5826 deprecated.
5827
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005828 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005829
5830
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005831option ldap-check
5832 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5834 yes | no | yes | yes
5835 Arguments : none
5836
5837 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5838 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5839 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5840 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5841
5842 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5843 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5844
5845 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5846 configure it.
5847
5848 Example :
5849 option ldap-check
5850
5851 See also : "option httpchk"
5852
5853
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005854option external-check
5855 Use external processes for server health checks
5856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5857 yes | no | yes | yes
5858
5859 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5860 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5861 command".
5862
5863 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5864
5865 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5866
5867
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005868option log-health-checks
5869no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005870 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5872 yes | no | yes | yes
5873 Arguments : none
5874
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005875 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5876 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5877 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005878
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005879 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5880 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5881 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5882 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5883 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5884
5885 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5886 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005887
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005888 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5889 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5890 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005891
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005892
5893option log-separate-errors
5894no option log-separate-errors
5895 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5897 yes | yes | yes | no
5898 Arguments : none
5899
5900 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5901 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5902 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5903 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5904 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5905 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5906 provides very important information.
5907
5908 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5909 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5910 error logs.
5911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005912 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005913 logging.
5914
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005915
5916option logasap
5917no option logasap
5918 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5920 yes | yes | yes | no
5921 Arguments : none
5922
5923 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5924 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5925 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5926 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5927 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5928 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5929 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005930 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005931 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5932 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5933
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005934 Examples :
5935 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5936 mode http
5937 option httplog
5938 option logasap
5939 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5940
5941 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5942 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5943 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5944 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005946 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005947 logging.
5948
5949
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005950option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005951 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5953 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005954 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005955 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5956 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005957 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005958
5959 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5960 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5961 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5962 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5963 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5964 in the MySQL table, like this :
5965
5966 USE mysql;
5967 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5968 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5969
5970 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5971 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5972 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5973 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5974 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5975 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5976 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5977 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5978 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5979
5980 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5981 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005982
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005983 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005984
5985 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5986 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5987 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5988 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005989 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5990 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005991
5992 See also: "option httpchk"
5993
5994
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005995option nolinger
5996no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005997 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005998 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5999 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006000 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006001
6002 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6003 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6004 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6005 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6006 connections.
6007
6008 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6009 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6010 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6011 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6012 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6013 this too.
6014
6015 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6016 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6017 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6018
6019 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6020 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6021 for servers.
6022
6023 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6024 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6025
6026
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006027option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6028 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6030 yes | yes | yes | yes
6031 Arguments :
6032 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6033 matching <network>
6034 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6035 header name.
6036
6037 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6038 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6039 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6040 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6041 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6042 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6043 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6044 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6045 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6046 possible that the client has already brought one.
6047
6048 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6049 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6050 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6051 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6052 header and requires different one.
6053
6054 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6055 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6056 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6057 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6058 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6059 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6060 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6061
6062 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6063 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6064 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6065 both are defined.
6066
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006067 Examples :
6068 # Original Destination address
6069 frontend www
6070 mode http
6071 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6072
6073 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6074 backend www
6075 mode http
6076 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6077
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006078 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6079 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006080
6081
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006082option persist
6083no option persist
6084 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6085 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6086 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006087 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006088
6089 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6090 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6091 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6092 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6093 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6094 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6095 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6096 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6097 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6098 redirected to another valid server.
6099
6100 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6101 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6102
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006103 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006104
6105
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006106option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6107 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6109 yes | no | yes | yes
6110 Arguments :
6111 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6112 PostgreSQL server.
6113
6114 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6115 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6116 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6117 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6118
6119 See also: "option httpchk"
6120
6121
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006122option prefer-last-server
6123no option prefer-last-server
6124 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6125 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6126 yes | no | yes | yes
6127 Arguments : none
6128
6129 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6130 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6131 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6132 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6133 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6134 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6135 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6136 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6137 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006138 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6139 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6140 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6141 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6142 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6143 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6144 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006145
6146 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6147 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6148
6149 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6150
6151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006152option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006153option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006154no option redispatch
6155 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6156 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6157 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006158 Arguments :
6159 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6160 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6161 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6162 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6163 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6164 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6165 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6166 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6167 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006169
6170 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6171 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6172 be able to access the service anymore.
6173
6174 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6175 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6176
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006177 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006178 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6179 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006180
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006181 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6182 "redisp" keywords.
6183
6184 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6185 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6186
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006187 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006188
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006189
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006190option redis-check
6191 Use redis health checks for server testing
6192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6193 yes | no | yes | yes
6194 Arguments : none
6195
6196 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6197 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6198 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6199 find the "+PONG" response message.
6200
6201 Example :
6202 option redis-check
6203
6204 See also : "option httpchk"
6205
6206
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006207option smtpchk
6208option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6209 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6211 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006212 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006213 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6214 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6215 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6216
6217 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6218 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6219 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6220
6221 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6222 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6223 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6224 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6225 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6226 dead server.
6227
6228 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6229 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6230 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6231 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6232
6233 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6234 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6235 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6236 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006237 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006238
6239 Example :
6240 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6241
6242 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6243
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006244
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006245option socket-stats
6246no option socket-stats
6247
6248 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6250 yes | yes | yes | no
6251
6252 Arguments : none
6253
6254
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006255option splice-auto
6256no option splice-auto
6257 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6259 yes | yes | yes | yes
6260 Arguments : none
6261
6262 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6263 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6264 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6265 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006266 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006267 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6268 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6269 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6270 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6271
6272 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6273 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6274 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6275 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6276 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6277 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6278 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6279 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6280 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6281 keyword.
6282
6283 Example :
6284 option splice-auto
6285
6286 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6287 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6288
6289 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6290 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6291
6292
6293option splice-request
6294no option splice-request
6295 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6297 yes | yes | yes | yes
6298 Arguments : none
6299
6300 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006301 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006302 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6303 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6304 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6305 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6306
6307 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6308
6309 Example :
6310 option splice-request
6311
6312 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6313 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6314
6315 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6316 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6317
6318
6319option splice-response
6320no option splice-response
6321 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6323 yes | yes | yes | yes
6324 Arguments : none
6325
6326 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006327 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006328 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6329 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6330 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6331 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6332
6333 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6334
6335 Example :
6336 option splice-response
6337
6338 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6339 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6340
6341 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6342 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6343
6344
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006345option srvtcpka
6346no option srvtcpka
6347 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6349 yes | no | yes | yes
6350 Arguments : none
6351
6352 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6353 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6354 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6355 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6356
6357 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6358 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6359 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6360 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6361
6362 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6363 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6364 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6365 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6366 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6367
6368 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6369
6370 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6371 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6372 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6373
6374 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6375 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6376
6377 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6378
6379
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006380option ssl-hello-chk
6381 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6383 yes | no | yes | yes
6384 Arguments : none
6385
6386 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6387 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6388 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6389 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6390 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6391 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6392 hello message.
6393
6394 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6395 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6396 messages, which is appreciable.
6397
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006398 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6399 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6400 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006401
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006402 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6403
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006404
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006405option tcp-check
6406 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6407 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6408 yes | no | yes | yes
6409
6410 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6411 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6412
6413 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6414 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6415 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6416
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006417 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006418 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6419 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6420 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6421 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6422 only.
6423
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006424 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006425 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6426 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6427 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6428 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6429
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006430 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006431 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6432 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006433 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006434 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6435 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6436 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6437 the respective protocols.
6438 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6439 analysed.
6440
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006441 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6442 script.
6443
6444 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6445 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6446 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6447 The "comment" is of course optional.
6448
6449
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006450 Examples :
6451 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6452 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006453 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006454
6455 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6456 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006457 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006458
6459 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6460 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006461 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006462 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006463 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006464 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006465 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006466 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006467 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6468 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006469 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006470 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6471 tcp-check expect string +OK
6472
6473 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6474 (send many headers before analyzing)
6475 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006476 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006477 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6478 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6479 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6480 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006481 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006482
6483
6484 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6485
6486
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006487option tcp-smart-accept
6488no option tcp-smart-accept
6489 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6491 yes | yes | yes | no
6492 Arguments : none
6493
6494 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6495 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6496 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6497 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6498 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6499 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6500
6501 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6502 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6503 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6504 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6505
6506 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6507 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6508 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6509 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6510
6511 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6512 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6513 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6514
6515 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6516 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6517 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6518
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006519 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6520
6521
6522option tcp-smart-connect
6523no option tcp-smart-connect
6524 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6526 yes | no | yes | yes
6527 Arguments : none
6528
6529 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6530 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6531 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6532 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6533 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6534
6535 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6536 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6537 complex.
6538
6539 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6540 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6541 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6542
6543 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6544 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6545
6546 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6547
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006548
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006549option tcpka
6550 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6552 yes | yes | yes | yes
6553 Arguments : none
6554
6555 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6556 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6557 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6558 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6559
6560 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6561 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6562 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6563 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6564
6565 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6566 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6567 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6568 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6569 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6570
6571 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6572
6573 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6574 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6575 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6576 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6577 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6578 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6579 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6580 backends.
6581
6582 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6583
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006584
6585option tcplog
6586 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6588 yes | yes | yes | yes
6589 Arguments : none
6590
6591 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6592 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6593 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6594 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6595 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6596 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6597 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6598 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6599
6600 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6601
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006602 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006603
6604
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006605option transparent
6606no option transparent
6607 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006609 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006610 Arguments : none
6611
6612 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6613 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6614 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6615 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6616 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6617 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6618 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6619 appropriate server.
6620
6621 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6622 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6623
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006624 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006625 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006626
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006627
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006628external-check command <command>
6629 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6631 yes | no | yes | yes
6632
6633 Arguments :
6634 <command> is the external command to run
6635
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006636 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6637
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006638 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006639
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006640 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6641 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6642 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6643 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6644 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6645 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006646
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006647 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6648
6649 Environment variables :
6650 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6651 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6652
6653 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6654
6655 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6656
6657 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6658 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6659 for a UNIX socket).
6660
6661 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6662
6663 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6664
6665 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6666
6667 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6668
6669 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6670
6671 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6672 socket).
6673
6674 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6675 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6676
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006677 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6678 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6679 failed.
6680
6681 Example :
6682 external-check command /bin/true
6683
6684 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6685
6686
6687external-check path <path>
6688 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6690 yes | no | yes | yes
6691
6692 Arguments :
6693 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6694
6695 The default path is "".
6696
6697 Example :
6698 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6699
6700 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6701 "external-check command"
6702
6703
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006704persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006705persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006706 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6708 yes | no | yes | yes
6709 Arguments :
6710 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006711 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6712 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006713
6714 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6715 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6716 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6717 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6718 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6719 forwarded to this server.
6720
6721 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6722 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6723 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006724 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006725 a single "listen" section.
6726
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006727 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6728 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6729 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6730
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006731 Example :
6732 listen tse-farm
6733 bind :3389
6734 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6735 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6736 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6737 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6738 persist rdp-cookie
6739 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006740 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006741 balance rdp-cookie
6742 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6743 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6744
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006745 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6746 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006747
6748
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006749rate-limit sessions <rate>
6750 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6752 yes | yes | yes | no
6753 Arguments :
6754 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6755 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6756
6757 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6758 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6759 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6760 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6761 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6762 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6763
6764 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6765 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6766 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6767 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6768
6769 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6770 listen smtp
6771 mode tcp
6772 bind :25
6773 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006774 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006775
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006776 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6777 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6778 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006779
6780 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6781
6782
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006783redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6784redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6785redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006786 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6788 no | yes | yes | yes
6789
6790 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006791 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006792
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006793 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006794 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006795 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6796 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6797 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006798
6799 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6800 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6801 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6802 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6803 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006804 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6805 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6806 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6807 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006808
6809 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6810 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6811 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6812 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6813 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6814 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006815 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006816 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006817 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6818 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6819 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006820
6821 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006822 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6823 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6824 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006825 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006826 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6827 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6828 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6829 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006830
6831 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6832 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6833
6834 - "drop-query"
6835 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6836 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6837 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6838 with a location-type redirect.
6839
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006840 - "append-slash"
6841 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6842 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6843 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6844 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6845
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006846 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6847 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6848 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6849 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6850 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6851 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6852 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6853
6854 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6855 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6856 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6857 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6858 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6859 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6860 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006861
6862 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6863 acl clear dst_port 80
6864 acl secure dst_port 8080
6865 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006866 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006867 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006868 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6869
6870 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006871 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6872 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6873 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006874 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006875
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006876 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6877 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6878 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6879
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006880 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006881 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006882
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006883 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006884 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6885 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6886 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006887
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006888 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006889
6890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006891redisp (deprecated)
6892redispatch (deprecated)
6893 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6894 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6895 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006896 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006897
6898 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6899 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6900 be able to access the service anymore.
6901
6902 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6903 redistribute them to a working server.
6904
6905 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6906 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6907 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006908
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006909 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6910 "option redispatch" instead.
6911
6912 See also : "option redispatch"
6913
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006914
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006915reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006916 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6918 no | yes | yes | yes
6919 Arguments :
6920 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6921 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006922 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006923
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006924 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6925 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6926
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006927 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6928 the last header of an HTTP request.
6929
6930 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6931 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6932 responses.
6933
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006934 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6935 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6936 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6937
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006938 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
6939 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006940
6941
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006942reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6943reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006944 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6946 no | yes | yes | yes
6947 Arguments :
6948 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6949 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6950 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6951 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6952 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6953 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6954 ignores case.
6955
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006956 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6957 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6958
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006959 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6960 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6961 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6962 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006963 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006964
6965 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6966 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6967
6968 Example :
6969 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6970 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6971 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6972
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006973 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
6974 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006975
6976
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006977reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6978reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006979 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6981 no | yes | yes | yes
6982 Arguments :
6983 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6984 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6985 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6986 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6987 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6988 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6989
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006990 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6991 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6992
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006993 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6994 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6995 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6996 next servers.
6997
6998 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6999 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7000 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7001
7002 Example :
7003 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7004 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7005 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7006
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007007 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7008 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007009
7010
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007011reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7012reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007013 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7015 no | yes | yes | yes
7016 Arguments :
7017 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7018 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7019 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7020 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7021 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7022 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7023 case.
7024
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007025 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7026 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7027
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007028 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7029 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7030 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7031 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007032 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007033
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007034 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007035 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007036 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007037
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007038 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7039 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7040
7041 Example :
7042 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7043 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7044 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7045
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007046 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7047 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007048
7049
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007050reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7051reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007052 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7054 no | yes | yes | yes
7055 Arguments :
7056 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7057 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7058 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7059 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7060 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7061 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7062 case.
7063
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007064 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7065 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7066
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007067 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7068 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7069 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7070 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7071
7072 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7073 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7074
7075 Example :
7076 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7077 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7078 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7079 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7080
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007081 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7082 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007083
7084
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007085reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7086reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007087 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7089 no | yes | yes | yes
7090 Arguments :
7091 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7092 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7093 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7094 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7095 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7096 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7097
7098 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7099 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7100 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7101 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007102 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007103
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007104 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7105 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7106
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007107 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7108 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7109 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7110
7111 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7112 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7113 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7114 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7115 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7116
7117 Example :
7118 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007119 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007120 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7121 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7122
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007123 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7124 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007125
7126
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007127reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7128reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007129 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7131 no | yes | yes | yes
7132 Arguments :
7133 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7134 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7135 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7136 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7137 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7138 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7139 ignores case.
7140
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007141 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7142 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7143
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007144 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7145 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007146 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7147 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7148 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007149 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7150 not set.
7151
7152 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7153 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7154 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7155 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7156 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7157
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007158 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007159 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7160 # block all others.
7161 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7162 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7163
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007164 # block bad guys
7165 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7166 reqitarpit . if badguys
7167
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007168 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7169 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007170
7171
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007172retries <value>
7173 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7174 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7175 yes | no | yes | yes
7176 Arguments :
7177 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7178 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7179 default value is 3.
7180
7181 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7182 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7183 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7184
7185 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007186 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7187 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007188
7189 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7190 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7191
7192 See also : "option redispatch"
7193
7194
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007195rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007196 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7198 no | yes | yes | yes
7199 Arguments :
7200 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7201 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007202 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007203
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007204 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7205 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7206
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007207 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7208 the last header of an HTTP response.
7209
7210 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7211 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7212 responses.
7213
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007214 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7215 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007216
7217
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007218rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7219rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007220 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7222 no | yes | yes | yes
7223 Arguments :
7224 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7225 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7226 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7227 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7228 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7229 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7230 ignores case.
7231
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007232 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7233 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7234
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007235 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7236 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007237 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007238 client.
7239
7240 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7241 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7242 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7243
7244 Example :
7245 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007246 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007247
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007248 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7249 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007250
7251
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007252rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7253rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007254 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7256 no | yes | yes | yes
7257 Arguments :
7258 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7259 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7260 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7261 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7262 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7263 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7264 ignores case.
7265
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007266 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7267 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7268
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007269 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7270 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7271 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7272 case-sensitive.
7273
7274 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007275 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7276 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7277 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007278
7279 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7280 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7281
7282 Example :
7283 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7284 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7285
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007286 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7287 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007288
7289
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007290rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7291rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007292 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7294 no | yes | yes | yes
7295 Arguments :
7296 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7297 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7298 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7299 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7300 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7301 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7302 ignores case.
7303
7304 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7305 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7306 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7307 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007308 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007309
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007310 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7311 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7312
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007313 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7314 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7315 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7316
7317 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7318 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7319 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7320 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7321 are not case-sensitive.
7322
7323 Example :
7324 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7325 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7326
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007327 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7328 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007329
7330
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007331server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007332 Declare a server in a backend
7333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7334 no | no | yes | yes
7335 Arguments :
7336 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007337 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007338 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007339
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007340 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7341 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7342 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7343 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007344 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7345 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7346 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7347 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7348 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007349 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7350 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7351 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7352 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7353 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7354 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7355 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007356 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007357 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7358 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
7359 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007360
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007361 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007362 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7363 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7364 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7365 adding this value to the client's port.
7366
7367 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7368 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007369 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007370
7371 Examples :
7372 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7373 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007374 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007375 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7376 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7377 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007378
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007379 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7380 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7381 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7382 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7383 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7384
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007385 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7386 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007387
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007388server-state-file-name [<file>]
7389 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7390 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7391 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7392 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7393 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7394 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7395
7396 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7397 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7398
7399 global
7400 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7401
7402 backend bk
7403 load-server-state-from-file
7404
7405 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7406 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007407
7408source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007409source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007410source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007411 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7413 yes | no | yes | yes
7414 Arguments :
7415 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7416 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007417
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007418 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007419 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7420 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7421 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7422 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7423 supported prefixes are :
7424 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7425 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7426 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007427 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007428 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7429 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007430
7431 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7432 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007433 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7434 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7435 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007436
7437 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7438 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7439 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7440 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7441 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7442 <addr>.
7443
7444 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7445 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7446 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7447 port.
7448
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007449 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7450 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7451 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7452 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007453 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007454 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7455 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7456 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7457 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7458 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7459 HTTP header.
7460
7461 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7462 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007463 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007464 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7465 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7466 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7467 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7468 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7469 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7470 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7471
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007472 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7473 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7474 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7475 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7476 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7477 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7478
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007479 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7480 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7481 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7482 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7483
7484 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7485 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7486 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7487 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7488 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7489 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7490
7491 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7492 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7493 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7494 there are two methods :
7495
7496 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7497 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7498 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7499 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7500 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7501 of the client ranges may be used.
7502
7503 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7504 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7505 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7506 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7507 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7508 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7509 same session.
7510
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007511 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7512 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7513 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007514 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007515
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007516 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7517
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007518 Examples :
7519 backend private
7520 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7521 source 192.168.1.200
7522
7523 backend transparent_ssl1
7524 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7525 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7526
7527 backend transparent_ssl2
7528 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7529 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7530 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7531
7532 backend transparent_ssl3
7533 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7534 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7535 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7536
7537 backend transparent_smtp
7538 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7539 # with Tproxy version 4.
7540 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7541
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007542 backend transparent_http
7543 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7544 # proxy.
7545 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007547 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007548 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7549
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007550
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007551srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7552 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7554 yes | no | yes | yes
7555 Arguments :
7556 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7557 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7558 as explained at the top of this document.
7559
7560 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7561 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7562 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7563 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7564 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7565 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7566 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7567
7568 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7569 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7570 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7571 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7572 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007573 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007574 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007575 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007576
7577 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7578 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7579 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7580 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7581 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7582 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7583
7584 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7585 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7586
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007587 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7588 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007589
7590
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007591stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7592 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007594 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007595
7596 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7597 matched.
7598
7599 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7600 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7601
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007602 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7603 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7604 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7605
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007606 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7607 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7608 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7609 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007610
7611 Example :
7612 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7613 backend stats_localhost
7614 stats enable
7615 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7616
7617 Example :
7618 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7619 backend stats_auth
7620 stats enable
7621 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7622 stats admin if TRUE
7623
7624 Example :
7625 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7626 userlist stats-auth
7627 group admin users admin
7628 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7629 group readonly users haproxy
7630 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7631
7632 backend stats_auth
7633 stats enable
7634 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7635 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7636 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7637 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7638
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007639 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7640 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7641 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007642
7643
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007644stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7645 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007647 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007648 Arguments :
7649 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7650
7651 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7652
7653 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7654 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7655 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7656 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7657 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7658 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7659
7660 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7661 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7662 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007663 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007664
7665 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7666 report using "stats scope".
7667
7668 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7669 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7670 unobvious parameters.
7671
7672 Example :
7673 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7674 backend public_www
7675 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7676 stats enable
7677 stats hide-version
7678 stats scope .
7679 stats uri /admin?stats
7680 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7681 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7682 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7683
7684 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7685 backend private_monitoring
7686 stats enable
7687 stats uri /admin?stats
7688 stats refresh 5s
7689
7690 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7691
7692
7693stats enable
7694 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007696 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007697 Arguments : none
7698
7699 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7700 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7701 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7702 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7703 - stats auth : no authentication
7704 - stats scope : no restriction
7705
7706 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7707 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7708 unobvious parameters.
7709
7710 Example :
7711 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7712 backend public_www
7713 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7714 stats enable
7715 stats hide-version
7716 stats scope .
7717 stats uri /admin?stats
7718 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7719 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7720 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7721
7722 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7723 backend private_monitoring
7724 stats enable
7725 stats uri /admin?stats
7726 stats refresh 5s
7727
7728 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7729
7730
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007731stats hide-version
7732 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007734 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007735 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007736
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007737 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7738 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7739 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7740 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7741 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7742 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007743
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007744 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7745 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7746 unobvious parameters.
7747
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007748 Example :
7749 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7750 backend public_www
7751 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007752 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007753 stats hide-version
7754 stats scope .
7755 stats uri /admin?stats
7756 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7757 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7758 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007759
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007760 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7761 backend private_monitoring
7762 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007763 stats uri /admin?stats
7764 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007765
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007766 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007767
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007768
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007769stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7770 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7771 Access control for statistics
7772
7773 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7774 no | no | yes | yes
7775
7776 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7777 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7778 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7779 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7780 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7781 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7782
7783 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7784 instance.
7785
7786 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7787 about ACL usage.
7788
7789
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007790stats realm <realm>
7791 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007793 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007794 Arguments :
7795 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7796 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7797 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7798
7799 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7800 using a backslash ('\').
7801
7802 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7803 only related to authentication.
7804
7805 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7806 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7807 unobvious parameters.
7808
7809 Example :
7810 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7811 backend public_www
7812 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7813 stats enable
7814 stats hide-version
7815 stats scope .
7816 stats uri /admin?stats
7817 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7818 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7819 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7820
7821 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7822 backend private_monitoring
7823 stats enable
7824 stats uri /admin?stats
7825 stats refresh 5s
7826
7827 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7828
7829
7830stats refresh <delay>
7831 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007833 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007834 Arguments :
7835 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7836 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7837 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7838 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7839 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7840 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7841
7842 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7843 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7844 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7845 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7846
7847 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7848 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7849 unobvious parameters.
7850
7851 Example :
7852 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7853 backend public_www
7854 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7855 stats enable
7856 stats hide-version
7857 stats scope .
7858 stats uri /admin?stats
7859 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7860 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7861 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7862
7863 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7864 backend private_monitoring
7865 stats enable
7866 stats uri /admin?stats
7867 stats refresh 5s
7868
7869 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7870
7871
7872stats scope { <name> | "." }
7873 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007875 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007876 Arguments :
7877 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7878 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7879 section in which the statement appears.
7880
7881 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7882 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7883 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7884 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7885 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7886 exists.
7887
7888 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7889 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7890 unobvious parameters.
7891
7892 Example :
7893 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7894 backend public_www
7895 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7896 stats enable
7897 stats hide-version
7898 stats scope .
7899 stats uri /admin?stats
7900 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7901 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7902 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7903
7904 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7905 backend private_monitoring
7906 stats enable
7907 stats uri /admin?stats
7908 stats refresh 5s
7909
7910 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7911
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007912
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007913stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007914 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007916 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007917
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007918 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007919 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7920
7921 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7922 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7923
7924 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7925 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007926 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007927
7928 Example :
7929 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7930 backend private_monitoring
7931 stats enable
7932 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7933 stats uri /admin?stats
7934 stats refresh 5s
7935
7936 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7937 global section.
7938
7939
7940stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007941 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7943 yes | yes | yes | yes
7944 Arguments : none
7945
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007946 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007947 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7948 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7949 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7950 - IP (socket, server)
7951 - cookie (backend, server)
7952
7953 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7954 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007955 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007956
7957 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7958
7959
7960stats show-node [ <name> ]
7961 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007963 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007964 Arguments:
7965 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7966 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7967
7968 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7969 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007970 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007971
7972 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7973 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7974 unobvious parameters.
7975
7976 Example:
7977 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7978 backend private_monitoring
7979 stats enable
7980 stats show-node Europe-1
7981 stats uri /admin?stats
7982 stats refresh 5s
7983
7984 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7985 section.
7986
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007987
7988stats uri <prefix>
7989 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007991 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007992 Arguments :
7993 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7994 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7995 query string.
7996
7997 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7998 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7999 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8000 possible to reach it in the application.
8001
8002 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008003 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008004 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8005 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8006 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8007 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8008
8009 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8010 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8011 an address or a port to statistics only.
8012
8013 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8014 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8015 unobvious parameters.
8016
8017 Example :
8018 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8019 backend public_www
8020 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8021 stats enable
8022 stats hide-version
8023 stats scope .
8024 stats uri /admin?stats
8025 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8026 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8027 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8028
8029 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8030 backend private_monitoring
8031 stats enable
8032 stats uri /admin?stats
8033 stats refresh 5s
8034
8035 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8036
8037
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008038stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8039 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008041 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008042
8043 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008044 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008045 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8046 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8047 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8048
8049 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8050 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8051 the "stick-table" statement.
8052
8053 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8054 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8055 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8056 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8057 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8058
8059 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8060 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8061 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8062 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8063 transformation rules.
8064
8065 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8066 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8067 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8068 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8069 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8070 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8071 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8072
8073 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8074 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8075 ACL based conditions.
8076
8077 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8078 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8079 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8080 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8081
8082 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8083 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8084 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8085 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8086
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008087 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8088 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8089 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8090
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008091 Example :
8092 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8093 # last 30 minutes
8094 backend pop
8095 mode tcp
8096 balance roundrobin
8097 stick store-request src
8098 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8099 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8100 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8101
8102 backend smtp
8103 mode tcp
8104 balance roundrobin
8105 stick match src table pop
8106 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8107 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8108
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008109 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008110 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008111
8112
8113stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8114 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8116 no | no | yes | yes
8117
8118 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8119 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8120 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8121 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8122
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008123 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8124 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8125 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8126
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008127 Examples :
8128 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008129 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008130
8131 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8132 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8133 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8134
8135
8136 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8137 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8138 backend http
8139 mode http
8140 balance roundrobin
8141 stick on src table https
8142 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8143 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8144 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8145
8146 backend https
8147 mode tcp
8148 balance roundrobin
8149 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8150 stick on src
8151 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8152 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8153
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008154 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008155
8156
8157stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8158 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8160 no | no | yes | yes
8161
8162 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008163 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008164 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8165 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8166 server is selected.
8167
8168 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8169 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8170 the "stick-table" statement.
8171
8172 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8173 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8174 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8175 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8176 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8177 address.
8178
8179 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8180 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8181 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8182 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8183 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8184 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8185 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8186 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8187 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8188 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8189
8190 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8191 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8192 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8193 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8194 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8195 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8196 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8197
8198 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8199 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8200 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8201 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8202
8203 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8204 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8205 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8206 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8207 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8208 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008209 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8210 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8211 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8212 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8213 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8214 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008215
8216 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8217 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8218 the request.
8219
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008220 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8221 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8222 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8223
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008224 Example :
8225 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8226 # last 30 minutes
8227 backend pop
8228 mode tcp
8229 balance roundrobin
8230 stick store-request src
8231 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8232 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8233 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8234
8235 backend smtp
8236 mode tcp
8237 balance roundrobin
8238 stick match src table pop
8239 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8240 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8241
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008242 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008243 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008244
8245
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008246stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008247 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8248 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008249 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008251 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008252
8253 Arguments :
8254 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8255 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8256 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8257 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8258
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008259 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8260 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8261 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8262 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8263
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008264 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8265 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8266 instance.
8267
8268 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8269 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8270 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8271 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8272 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8273 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008274 to 32 characters.
8275
8276 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8277 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8278 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008279 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008280 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8281 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008282
8283 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008284 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8285 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008286 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8287 increase.
8288
8289 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008290 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8291 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8292 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008293
8294 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8295 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8296 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8297 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8298 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8299 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8300 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8301 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8302 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8303 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8304 parameter (see below).
8305
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008306 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8307 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8308 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8309 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8310 soft restart.
8311
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008312 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8313 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008314
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008315 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8316 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8317 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8318 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8319 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008320 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008321 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8322 if not expiration delay is specified.
8323
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008324 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8325 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8326 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8327 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008328 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8329 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8330 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8331 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8332 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8333 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8334 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8335 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8336 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8337 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8338 types and their arguments.
8339
8340 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8341 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8342 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8343 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8344
8345 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8346 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8347 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8348 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8349
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008350 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8351 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8352 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8353 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8354 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8355 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8356
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008357 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8358 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8359 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8360 they were received.
8361
8362 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8363 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8364 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8365 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8366 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8367
8368 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8369 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8370 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8371 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8372 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8373
8374 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8375 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8376 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8377
8378 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8379 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8380 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8381 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8382 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8383
8384 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8385 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8386 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8387 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8388 the client side.
8389
8390 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8391 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8392 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8393 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8394 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8395 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8396 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8397
8398 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8399 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8400 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8401 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8402 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8403 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8404 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8405
8406 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8407 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8408 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8409 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8410 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8411 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8412
8413 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8414 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8415 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8416 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8417
8418 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8419 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8420 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8421 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8422 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8423 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8424 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8425 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8426 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8427 recommended for better fairness.
8428
8429 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8430 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8431 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8432 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8433
8434 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8435 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8436 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8437 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8438 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8439 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8440 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8441 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8442 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8443 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008444
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008445 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8446 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008447 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8448 reference it.
8449
8450 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8451 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008452 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8453 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8454 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008455
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008456 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8457 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8458 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8459 something that can be ignored.
8460
8461 Example:
8462 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8463 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8464 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8465 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8466
8467 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008468 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008469
8470
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008471stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008472 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8474 no | no | yes | yes
8475
8476 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008477 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008478 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8479 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8480 server is selected.
8481
8482 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8483 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8484 the "stick-table" statement.
8485
8486 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8487 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8488 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8489 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8490
8491 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8492 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8493 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8494 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8495 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8496 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008497 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008498 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8499 rules.
8500
8501 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8502 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8503 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8504 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8505 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8506 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8507 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8508
8509 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8510 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8511 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8512 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8513
8514 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8515 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8516 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8517 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8518 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8519 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008520 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8521 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8522 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8523 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8524 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8525 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8526 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8527 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8528 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008529
8530 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8531
8532 Example :
8533 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8534 backend https
8535 mode tcp
8536 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008537 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008538 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008539
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008540 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8541 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8542
8543 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8544 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8545 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8546
8547 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8548 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008549
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008550 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8551 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8552 # at offset 44.
8553
8554 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8555 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8556
8557 # Learn on response if server hello.
8558 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008559
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008560 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8561 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8562
8563 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8564 extraction.
8565
8566
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008567tcp-check connect [params*]
8568 Opens a new connection
8569 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8570 no | no | yes | yes
8571
8572 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8573 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8574 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8575
8576 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8577 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8578 of the sequence.
8579
8580 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8581 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8582 do.
8583
8584 Parameters :
8585 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8586 use the TCP connection.
8587
8588 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8589 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8590 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8591
8592 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8593
8594 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8595
8596 Examples:
8597 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8598 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8599 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8600 option tcp-check
8601 tcp-check connect
8602 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8603 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8604 tcp-check send \r\n
8605 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8606 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8607 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8608 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8609 tcp-check send \r\n
8610 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8611 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8612
8613 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8614 option tcp-check
8615 tcp-check connect port 110
8616 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8617 tcp-check connect port 143
8618 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8619 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8620
8621 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8622
8623
8624tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8625 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8626 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8627 no | no | yes | yes
8628
8629 Arguments :
8630 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8631 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8632 binary.
8633 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8634 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8635 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8636
8637 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8638 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8639 with the usual backslash ('\').
8640 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8641 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8642 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8643 used upper or lower case.
8644
8645
8646 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8647
8648 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8649 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8650 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8651 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8652 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8653 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8654 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8655 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8656
8657 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8658 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8659 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8660 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8661 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8662 expression.
8663
8664 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8665 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8666 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8667 this exact hexadecimal string.
8668 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8669
8670 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8671 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8672 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8673 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8674 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8675 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8676 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8677 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8678 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8679 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8680 the null character.
8681
8682 Examples :
8683 # perform a POP check
8684 option tcp-check
8685 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8686
8687 # perform an IMAP check
8688 option tcp-check
8689 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8690
8691 # look for the redis master server
8692 option tcp-check
8693 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008694 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008695 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8696 tcp-check expect string role:master
8697 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8698 tcp-check expect string +OK
8699
8700
8701 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8702 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8703
8704
8705tcp-check send <data>
8706 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8707 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8708 no | no | yes | yes
8709
8710 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8711 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8712
8713 Examples :
8714 # look for the redis master server
8715 option tcp-check
8716 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8717 tcp-check expect string role:master
8718
8719 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8720 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8721
8722
8723tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8724 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8725 tcp health check
8726 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8727 no | no | yes | yes
8728
8729 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8730 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8731 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8732 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8733 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8734 hexadecimal string.
8735 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8736
8737 Examples :
8738 # redis check in binary
8739 option tcp-check
8740 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8741 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8742
8743
8744 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8745 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8746
8747
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008748tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8749 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8751 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008752 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008753 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8754 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008755
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008756 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008757
8758 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8759 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008760 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8761 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8762 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8763 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8764 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8765 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008766
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008767 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8768 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8769 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8770 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008771
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008772 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008773 - accept :
8774 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8775 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8776 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008777
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008778 - reject :
8779 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8780 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8781 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8782 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8783 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8784 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8785 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8786 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8787 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8788 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8789 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008790 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008791
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008792 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8793 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8794 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8795 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8796 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8797 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8798 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8799 hosts.
8800
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008801 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8802 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8803 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8804 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8805 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8806 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8807 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8808 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8809
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008810 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8811 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8812 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8813 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8814 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8815 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8816 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8817 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8818 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008819 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8820 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008821
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008822 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008823 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008824 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008825 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008826 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8827 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008828 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008829 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8830 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8831 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8832 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8833 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008834
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008835 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008836 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008837 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008838 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8839 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8840 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8841 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008842
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008843 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8844 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8845 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8846 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008847
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008848 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8849 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8850 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8851 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8852 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008853 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8854 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8855 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8856 layer7 information is extracted.
8857
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008858 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8859 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8860 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8861 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8862 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008863
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008864 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8865 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8866 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8867 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8868
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008869 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8870 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8871 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8872 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8873 continues.
8874
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008875 - set-src <expr> :
8876 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8877 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8878 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8879 set-src"
8880
8881 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8882 followed by some converters.
8883
8884 Example:
8885
8886 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8887
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008888 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
8889 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008890
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008891 - set-src-port <expr> :
8892 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8893 expression.
8894
8895 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8896 followed by some converters.
8897
8898 Example:
8899
8900 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
8901
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008902 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
8903 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
8904 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008905
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008906 - set-dst <expr> :
8907 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
8908 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
8909 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8910 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8911 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8912
8913 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8914 followed by some converters.
8915
8916 Example:
8917
8918 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
8919 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
8920
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008921 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
8922 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
8923
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008924 - set-dst-port <expr> :
8925 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
8926 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8927 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8928
8929
8930 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8931 followed by some converters.
8932
8933 Example:
8934
8935 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
8936
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008937 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
8938 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
8939 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
8940
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008941 - "silent-drop" :
8942 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8943 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8944 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8945 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8946 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8947 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8948 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8949 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8950 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8951 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8952 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8953 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8954 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8955 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8956 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8957 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8958
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008959 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8960 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8961 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008962
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008963 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8964 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8965 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008966
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008967 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008968 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008969 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008970
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008971 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8972 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8973 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008974
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008975 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008976 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8977 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008978
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008979 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8980
8981 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8982
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008983 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8984
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008985 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008986
8987
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008988tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8989 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008991 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008992 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008993 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8994 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008995
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008996 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008997
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008998 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8999 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9000 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9001 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9002 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009003
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009004 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9005 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9006 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9007 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009008 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9009 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9010 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9011 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9012 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9013 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009014 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009015 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009016
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009017 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9018 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9019 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9020 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009021
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009022 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009023 - accept : the request is accepted
9024 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9025 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009026 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009027 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009028 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009029 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009030 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009031
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009032 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9033 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009034
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009035 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9036 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9037 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9038 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9039 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9040 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009041
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009042 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009043 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9044 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009045
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009046 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009047 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9048 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9049 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9050 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009051 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9052 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9053 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009054
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009055 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009056 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9057 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9058 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009059
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009060 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009061 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9062 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009063
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009064 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9065 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
9066 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9067 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009068 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009069 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009070 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009071 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9072 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009073 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009074 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
9075 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009076
9077 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9078 followed by some converters.
9079
9080 Example:
9081
9082 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9083
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009084 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009085 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9086 # and reject everything else.
9087 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9088 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009089 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009090 tcp-request content reject
9091
9092 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009093 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9094 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9095 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009096 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009097
9098 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9099 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9100 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009101 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009102 tcp-request content reject
9103
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009104 Example:
9105 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
9106 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009107 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009108
9109 Example:
9110 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9111 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009112 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009113
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009114 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
9115 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
9116
9117 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009118 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009119 # protecting all our sites
9120 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009121 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9122 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009123 ...
9124 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9125
9126 backend http_dynamic
9127 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009128 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009129 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009130 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
9131 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
9132 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009133 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009135 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009136
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009137 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session", and
9138 "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009139
9140
9141tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9142 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009144 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009145 Arguments :
9146 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9147 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9148 as explained at the top of this document.
9149
9150 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9151 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9152 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9153 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9154 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9155
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009156 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9157 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9158 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9159 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9160
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009161 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9162 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009163 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009164 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009165 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9166 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9167 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9168 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009169
9170 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9171 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9172 it pass through unaffected.
9173
9174 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9175 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9176 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009177 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009178 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9179 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009180 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9181 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9182 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009183
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009184 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009185 "timeout client".
9186
9187
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009188tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9189 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9191 no | no | yes | yes
9192 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009193 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9194 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009195
9196 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9197
9198 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9199 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9200 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009201 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9202 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009203
9204 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9205
9206 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9207 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9208 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9209 inserted.
9210
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009211 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009212 - accept :
9213 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9214 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9215 the rules evaluation.
9216
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009217 - close :
9218 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9219 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9220 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9221 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9222 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9223 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009224 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009225 protocols.
9226
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009227 - reject :
9228 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9229 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009230 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009231
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009232 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9233 Sets a variable.
9234
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009235 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9236 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9237 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9238 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9239
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009240 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9241 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9242 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9243 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9244 continues.
9245
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009246 - "silent-drop" :
9247 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9248 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9249 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9250 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9251 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9252 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9253 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9254 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9255 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9256 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9257 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9258 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9259 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9260 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9261 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9262 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9263
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009264 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9265 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9266 for changing the default action to a reject.
9267
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009268 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9269 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9270 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9271 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009272 period.
9273
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009274 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9275 declared inline.
9276
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009277 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9278 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
9279 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9280 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009281 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009282 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009283 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009284 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9285 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009286 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009287 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
9288 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009289
9290 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9291 followed by some converters.
9292
9293 Example:
9294
9295 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9296
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009297 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9298
9299 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9300
9301
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009302tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9303 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9305 no | yes | yes | no
9306 Arguments :
9307 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9308 below.
9309
9310 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9311
9312 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9313 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9314 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9315 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9316 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9317 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9318 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9319 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9320 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9321 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9322 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9323 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9324 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9325 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9326 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9327 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9328 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9329 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9330 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9331 instead.
9332
9333 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9334 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9335 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9336 rules which may be inserted.
9337
9338 Several types of actions are supported :
9339 - accept : the request is accepted
9340 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9341 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9342 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9343 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9344 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9345 - silent-drop
9346
9347 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9348 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9349 sections for a complete description.
9350
9351 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9352 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9353 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9354
9355 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9356 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9357 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9358 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9359 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9360
9361 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9362 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9363
9364 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9365 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9366 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9367
9368 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9369 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9370 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9371
9372 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9373 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9374 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9375
9376 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9377 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9378 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9379
9380 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9381
9382 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9383
9384
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009385tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9386 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9388 no | no | yes | yes
9389 Arguments :
9390 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9391 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9392 as explained at the top of this document.
9393
9394 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9395
9396
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009397timeout check <timeout>
9398 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9399 established.
9400
9401 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9402 yes | no | yes | yes
9403 Arguments:
9404 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9405 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9406 as explained at the top of this document.
9407
9408 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9409 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9410 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9411 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009412 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9413 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9414 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009415
9416 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9417 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9418
9419 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9420 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009421 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009422
9423 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9424 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9425 forget about it.
9426
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009427 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9428 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009429
9430
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009431timeout client <timeout>
9432timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9433 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9435 yes | yes | yes | no
9436 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009437 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009438 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9439 as explained at the top of this document.
9440
9441 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9442 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9443 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009444 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9445 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9446 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9447 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009448 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9449 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9450 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009451 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009452 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009453 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9454 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009455 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9456 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009457
9458 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9459 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9460 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9461 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9462 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9463 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9464
9465 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9466 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9467 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9468
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009469 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9470 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009471
9472
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009473timeout client-fin <timeout>
9474 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9476 yes | yes | yes | no
9477 Arguments :
9478 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9479 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9480 as explained at the top of this document.
9481
9482 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9483 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9484 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9485 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9486 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9487 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9488 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9489 down in one direction.
9490
9491 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9492 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9493 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9494
9495 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9496
9497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009498timeout connect <timeout>
9499timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9500 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9502 yes | no | yes | yes
9503 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009504 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009505 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9506 as explained at the top of this document.
9507
9508 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009509 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009510 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009511 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009512 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9513 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009514
9515 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9516 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9517 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9518 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9519 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9520 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9521
9522 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9523 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9524 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9525
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009526 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9527 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009528
9529
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009530timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9531 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9533 yes | yes | yes | yes
9534 Arguments :
9535 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9536 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9537 as explained at the top of this document.
9538
9539 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9540 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9541 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9542 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9543 once the request has started to present itself.
9544
9545 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9546 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9547 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9548 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9549 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9550
9551 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9552 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9553 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9554 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9555
9556 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9557 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9558 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9559 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9560 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009561 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009562
9563 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9564 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9565 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9566 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9567
9568 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9569
9570
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009571timeout http-request <timeout>
9572 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009574 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009575 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009576 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009577 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9578 as explained at the top of this document.
9579
9580 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9581 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9582 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9583 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9584 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9585 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9586 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009587 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9588 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9589 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9590 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9591 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009592 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9593 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009594
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009595 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9596 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9597 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9598 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9599 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009600 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009601
9602 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9603 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9604 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9605 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9606 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9607
9608 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009609 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9610 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9611 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009612
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009613 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009614 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009615
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009616
9617timeout queue <timeout>
9618 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9620 yes | no | yes | yes
9621 Arguments :
9622 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9623 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9624 as explained at the top of this document.
9625
9626 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9627 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9628 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9629 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9630 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9631
9632 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9633 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9634 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9635 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9636
9637 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9638
9639
9640timeout server <timeout>
9641timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9642 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9644 yes | no | yes | yes
9645 Arguments :
9646 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9647 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9648 as explained at the top of this document.
9649
9650 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9651 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9652 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9653 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9654 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9655 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9656 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9657
9658 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9659 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9660 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9661 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9662 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009663 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009664 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009665 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9666 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9667 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9668 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009669
9670 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9671 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9672 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9673 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9674 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9675 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9676
9677 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9678 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9679 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9680
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009681 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009682
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009683
9684timeout server-fin <timeout>
9685 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9687 yes | no | yes | yes
9688 Arguments :
9689 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9690 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9691 as explained at the top of this document.
9692
9693 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9694 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9695 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9696 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9697 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9698 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9699 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9700 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9701 situations, it should not be needed.
9702
9703 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9704 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9705 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9706
9707 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9708
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009709
9710timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009711 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9713 yes | yes | yes | yes
9714 Arguments :
9715 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9716 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9717 as explained at the top of this document.
9718
9719 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9720 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9721 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9722
9723 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9724 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9725 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9726 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009727 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009728
9729 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9730
9731
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009732timeout tunnel <timeout>
9733 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9735 yes | no | yes | yes
9736 Arguments :
9737 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9738 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9739 as explained at the top of this document.
9740
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009741 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009742 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9743 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9744 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9745 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9746 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9747 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9748 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9749 specified.
9750
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009751 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9752 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9753 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9754 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9755 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9756 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9757 state.
9758
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009759 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9760 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9761 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9762 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9763 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9764
9765 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9766 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9767 forget about it.
9768
9769 Example :
9770 defaults http
9771 option http-server-close
9772 timeout connect 5s
9773 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009774 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009775 timeout server 30s
9776 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9777
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009778 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009779
9780
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009781transparent (deprecated)
9782 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009784 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009785 Arguments : none
9786
9787 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9788 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9789 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9790 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9791 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9792 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9793 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9794 appropriate server.
9795
9796 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9797
9798 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9799 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9800
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009801 See also: "option transparent"
9802
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009803unique-id-format <string>
9804 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9806 yes | yes | yes | no
9807 Arguments :
9808 <string> is a log-format string.
9809
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009810 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9811 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9812 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9813 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009814
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009815 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9816 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9817 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9818 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9819 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9820 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9821 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9822 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009823
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009824 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9825 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009826
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009827 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009828
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009829 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009830
9831 will generate:
9832
9833 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9834
9835 See also: "unique-id-header"
9836
9837unique-id-header <name>
9838 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9840 yes | yes | yes | no
9841 Arguments :
9842 <name> is the name of the header.
9843
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009844 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9845 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009846
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009847 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009848
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009849 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009850 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9851
9852 will generate:
9853
9854 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9855
9856 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009857
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009858use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009859 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9861 no | yes | yes | no
9862 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009863 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9864 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009865
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009866 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9867 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009868
9869 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9870 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9871 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009872 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9873 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9874 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9875 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009876
9877 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9878 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9879 assign the backend.
9880
9881 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9882 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9883 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9884 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9885 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9886 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9887
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009888 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009889 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009890 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9891 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9892 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9893
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009894 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9895 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9896 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9897 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9898 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9899 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9900 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9901 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9902 cannot be forced from the request.
9903
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009904 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009905 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9906 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9907
9908 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9909 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009910
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009911
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009912use-server <server> if <condition>
9913use-server <server> unless <condition>
9914 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9916 no | no | yes | yes
9917 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009918 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009919
9920 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9921
9922 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9923 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9924 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9925
9926 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9927 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9928 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9929 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9930 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9931 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9932 matches will assign the server.
9933
9934 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9935 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9936 with the next rules until one matches.
9937
9938 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9939 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9940 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9941 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9942
9943 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9944 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9945 stripped.
9946
9947 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9948 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9949 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9950 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9951
9952 Example :
9953 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9954 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9955 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9956 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9957 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9958 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9959 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9960 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9961 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9962
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009963 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009964
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009965
99665. Bind and Server options
9967--------------------------
9968
9969The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9970depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9971settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9972written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9973described in this section.
9974
9975
99765.1. Bind options
9977-----------------
9978
9979The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9980as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9981no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9982parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9983while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9984provided immediately after the setting name.
9985
9986The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9987
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +01009988accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
9989 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
9990 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
9991 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
9992 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
9993 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
9994 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
9995 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
9996 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
9997 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009998 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
9999 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10000 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010001
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010002accept-proxy
10003 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010004 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10005 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010006 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10007 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10008 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10009 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10010 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10011 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10012 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010013 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10014 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010015
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010016alpn <protocols>
10017 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10018 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10019 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10020 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10021 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10022 initial NPN extension.
10023
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010024backlog <backlog>
10025 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10026 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10027
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010028ecdhe <named curve>
10029 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010030 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10031 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010032
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010033ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010034 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10035 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10036 client's certificate.
10037
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010038ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10039 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10040 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10041 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10042 error is ignored.
10043
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010044ca-sign-file <cafile>
10045 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10046 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10047 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10048 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10049 'generate-certificates' for details.
10050
10051ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
10052 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10053 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10054 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10055 'generate-certificates' for details.
10056
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010057ciphers <ciphers>
10058 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10059 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010060 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010061 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10062 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
10063
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010064crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010065 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10066 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10067 to verify client's certificate.
10068
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010069crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010070 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10071 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10072 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10073 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10074 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10075 file.
10076
10077 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10078 are loaded.
10079
10080 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010081 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010082 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10083 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10084 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10085 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10086 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10087 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10088 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010089
10090 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10091 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10092 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10093 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010094 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10095 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010096
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010097 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010098
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010099 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10100 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010101 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010102 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10103 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10104 clients).
10105
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010106 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10107 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10108 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10109 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10110 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10111 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10112 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10113 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10114 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10115 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10116 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10117 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10118 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10119
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010120 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10121 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10122 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10123 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10124 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10125
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010126 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10127 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10128 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10129 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010130
10131 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10132 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10133 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10134 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10135 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10136 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10137 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10138 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10139 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10140
10141 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10142
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010143 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010144 a cert bundle.
10145
10146 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10147 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10148 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10149 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10150 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10151 provide multi-cert support.
10152
10153 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10154
10155 Filename | CN | SAN
10156 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10157 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010158 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010159 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10160 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10161
10162 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10163 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10164 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10165 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
10166 suites.
10167
10168 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10169 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10170
10171 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10172 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10173 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10174
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010175crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010176 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10177 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010178 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010179 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010180
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010181crt-list <file>
10182 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010183 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
10184 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010185
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010186 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010187
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010188 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10189 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10190 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10191 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10192 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10193 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10194 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10195 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010196
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010197 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010198 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
10199 all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010200
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010201defer-accept
10202 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10203 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10204 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10205 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10206 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10207 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10208 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10209 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10210 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10211 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10212 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10213
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010214force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010215 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010216 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010217 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10218 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010219
10220force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010221 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010222 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10223 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010224
10225force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010226 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010227 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10228 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010229
10230force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010231 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010232 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10233 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010234
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010235generate-certificates
10236 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10237 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10238 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10239 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10240 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10241 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10242 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10243 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10244 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10245 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10246 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10247
10248 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10249 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10250 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10251 certificate is used many times.
10252
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010253gid <gid>
10254 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10255 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10256 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10257 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10258 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10259
10260group <group>
10261 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10262 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10263 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10264 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10265 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10266
10267id <id>
10268 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10269 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10270 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10271 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10272
10273interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010274 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10275 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10276 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10277 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10278 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10279 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10280 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010281
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010282level <level>
10283 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10284 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10285 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10286 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10287 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10288 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10289 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10290 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10291 counters).
10292 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10293 all counters).
10294
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010295maxconn <maxconn>
10296 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10297 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10298 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10299 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10300 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10301 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10302 eat all memory.
10303
10304mode <mode>
10305 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10306 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10307 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10308 UNIX sockets.
10309
10310mss <maxseg>
10311 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10312 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10313 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10314 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10315 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10316 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10317 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10318 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10319 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10320 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10321 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10322
10323name <name>
10324 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10325 page.
10326
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010327namespace <name>
10328 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10329 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10330 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10331 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10332
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010333nice <nice>
10334 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10335 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10336 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10337 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10338 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10339 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10340 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10341 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10342 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10343 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10344 one for an RDP socket.
10345
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010346no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010347 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010348 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010349 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010350 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10351 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010352 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010353
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010354no-tls-tickets
10355 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10356 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10357 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010358 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10359 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010360
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010361no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010362 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010363 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010364 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010365 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10366 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10367 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010368
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010369no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010370 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010371 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010372 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010373 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10374 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10375 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010376
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010377no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010378 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010379 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010380 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010381 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10382 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10383 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010384
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010385npn <protocols>
10386 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10387 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10388 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10389 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010390 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10391 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010392
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010393process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10394 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10395 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10396 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10397 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10398 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10399 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10400 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010401 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10402 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10403 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10404 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10405 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10406 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10407 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010408
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010409ssl
10410 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010411 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010412 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10413 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10414 to deciphered contents.
10415
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010416strict-sni
10417 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10418 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10419 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10420 See the "crt" option for more information.
10421
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010422tcp-ut <delay>
10423 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
10424 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10425 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
10426 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
10427 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10428 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10429 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10430 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10431 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10432 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10433 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10434
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010435tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010436 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010437 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10438 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10439 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10440 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10441 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10442 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10443 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010444 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10445 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10446 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010447
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010448tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10449 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10450 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10451 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10452 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10453 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10454 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10455 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10456 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10457 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10458 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10459
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010460transparent
10461 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10462 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10463 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10464 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10465 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10466 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10467 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10468 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10469 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10470 so check for support with your vendor.
10471
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010472v4v6
10473 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10474 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10475 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10476 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010477 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010478
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010479v6only
10480 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10481 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10482 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010483 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10484 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010485
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010486uid <uid>
10487 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10488 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10489 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10490 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10491 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10492
10493user <user>
10494 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10495 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10496 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10497 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10498 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10499
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010500verify [none|optional|required]
10501 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10502 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10503 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10504 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10505 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010506 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10507 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10508 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10509 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010510
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200105115.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010512------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010514The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10515which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10516arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10517settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10518after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10519Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10520address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010522 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010523 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010524
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010525The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010526
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010527addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010528 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010529 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10530 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10531 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10532 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10533 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010535 Supported in default-server: No
10536
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010537agent-check
10538 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010539 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10540 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10541 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10542 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010543
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010544 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010545 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010546 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10547 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10548 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010549
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010550 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10551 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10552 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10553 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10554 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10555
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010556 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10557 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010558
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010559 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10560 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10561 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010562
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010563 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10564 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10565 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010566
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010567 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10568 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10569 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10570 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10571 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10572 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10573 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010574
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010575 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10576 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010577
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010578 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10579 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10580 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10581 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10582 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10583 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10584 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10585 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10586 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010587
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010588 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10589 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010590 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10591 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10592 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010593 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010594
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010595 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10596 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010597
10598 Supported in default-server: No
10599
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010600agent-send <string>
10601 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10602 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10603 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10604 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10605 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10606
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010607agent-inter <delay>
10608 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10609 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10610
10611 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10612 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10613 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10614 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10615 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10616 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10617 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10618 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10619 of backends use the same servers.
10620
10621 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10622
10623 Supported in default-server: Yes
10624
10625agent-port <port>
10626 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10627
10628 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10629
10630 Supported in default-server: Yes
10631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010632backup
10633 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10634 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10635 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10636 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10637 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10638 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010639
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010640 Supported in default-server: No
10641
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010642ca-file <cafile>
10643 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10644 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10645 server's certificate.
10646
10647 Supported in default-server: No
10648
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010649check
10650 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010651 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10652 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10653 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10654 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10655 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10656 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10657 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010658 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10659 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10660 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010662 Supported in default-server: No
10663
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010664check-send-proxy
10665 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10666 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10667 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10668 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10669 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10670 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10671 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10672
10673 Supported in default-server: No
10674
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010675check-ssl
10676 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10677 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10678 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10679 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010680 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010681 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10682 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10683 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10684 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10685
10686 Supported in default-server: No
10687
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010688ciphers <ciphers>
10689 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010690 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010691 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10692 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10693 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10694 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10695 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10696 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10697
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010698 Supported in default-server: No
10699
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010700cookie <value>
10701 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10702 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10703 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10704 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10705 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10706 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10707 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10708
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010709 Supported in default-server: No
10710
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010711crl-file <crlfile>
10712 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10713 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10714 to verify server's certificate.
10715
10716 Supported in default-server: No
10717
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010718crt <cert>
10719 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10720 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10721 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10722 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10723 certificate request.
10724
10725 Supported in default-server: No
10726
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010727disabled
10728 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10729 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10730 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10731 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10732 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10733
10734 Supported in default-server: No
10735
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010736error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010737 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10738 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10739 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010741 Supported in default-server: Yes
10742
10743 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010744
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010745fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010746 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10747 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10748 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10749
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010750 Supported in default-server: Yes
10751
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010752force-sslv3
10753 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10754 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010755 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10756 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010757
10758 Supported in default-server: No
10759
10760force-tlsv10
10761 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010762 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10763 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010764
10765 Supported in default-server: No
10766
10767force-tlsv11
10768 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010769 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10770 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010771
10772 Supported in default-server: No
10773
10774force-tlsv12
10775 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010776 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10777 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010778
10779 Supported in default-server: No
10780
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010781id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010782 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10783 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10784 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010785
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010786 Supported in default-server: No
10787
10788inter <delay>
10789fastinter <delay>
10790downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010791 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10792 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10793 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10794 between checks depending on the server state :
10795
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010796 Server state | Interval used
10797 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10798 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10799 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10800 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10801 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10802 or yet unchecked. |
10803 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10804 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10805 | "inter" otherwise.
10806 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010807
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010808 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10809 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10810 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10811 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010812 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10813 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10814 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10815 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10816 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010818 Supported in default-server: Yes
10819
10820maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010821 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10822 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10823 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10824 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10825 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10826 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10827 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10828 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10829
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010830 Supported in default-server: Yes
10831
10832maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010833 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10834 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10835 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10836 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10837 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10838 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10839 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10840
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010841 Supported in default-server: Yes
10842
10843minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010844 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10845 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10846 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10847 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10848 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10849 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010850 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010851 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010853 Supported in default-server: Yes
10854
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010855namespace <name>
10856 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10857 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10858 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10859 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10860
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010861no-ssl-reuse
10862 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10863 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10864 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10865 and for paranoid users.
10866
10867 Supported in default-server: No
10868
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010869no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010870 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10871 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010872 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010873
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010874 Supported in default-server: No
10875
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010876no-tls-tickets
10877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10878 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10879 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010880 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10881 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010882
10883 Supported in default-server: No
10884
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010885no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010886 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010887 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10888 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010889 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10890 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10891 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010892
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010893 Supported in default-server: No
10894
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010895no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010896 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010897 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10898 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010899 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10900 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10901 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010902
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010903 Supported in default-server: No
10904
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010905no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010906 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010907 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10908 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010909 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10910 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10911 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010912
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010913 Supported in default-server: No
10914
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010915non-stick
10916 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10917 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10918 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10919
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010920 Supported in default-server: No
10921
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010922observe <mode>
10923 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10924 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10925 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10926 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10927 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10928 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010929 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010930
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010931 Supported in default-server: No
10932
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010933 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10934
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010935on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010936 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10937 Currently, four modes are available:
10938 - fastinter: force fastinter
10939 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10940 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10941 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10942 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010944 Supported in default-server: Yes
10945
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010946 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10947
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010948on-marked-down <action>
10949 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10950 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010951 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10952 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10953 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10954 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10955 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10956 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10957 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10958 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010959
10960 Actions are disabled by default
10961
10962 Supported in default-server: Yes
10963
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010964on-marked-up <action>
10965 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10966 Currently one action is available:
10967 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10968 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10969 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10970 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10971 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10972 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10973 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10974 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10975
10976 Actions are disabled by default
10977
10978 Supported in default-server: Yes
10979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010980port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010981 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10982 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10983 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10984 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10985 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10986 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10987
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010988 Supported in default-server: Yes
10989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010990redir <prefix>
10991 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10992 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10993 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10994 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10995 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10996 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10997 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10998 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010999 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011000 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11001 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11002 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11003 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11004 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11005
11006 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11007
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011008 Supported in default-server: No
11009
11010rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011011 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11012 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11013 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11014
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011015 Supported in default-server: Yes
11016
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011017resolve-prefer <family>
11018 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11019 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11020 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11021 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11022
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011023 Default value: ipv6
11024
11025 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011026
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011027 Example:
11028
11029 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011030
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011031resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11032 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11033 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
11034 avalailibility service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
11035 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11036 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11037 configured network, another address is selected.
11038
11039 Supported in default-server: Yes
11040
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011041 Example:
11042
11043 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011044
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011045resolvers <id>
11046 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11047 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011048 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11049 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11050 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11051 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011052
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011053 Supported in default-server: No
11054
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011055 Example:
11056
11057 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011058
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011059 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011060
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011061send-proxy
11062 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11063 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11064 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11065 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011066 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11067 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11068 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11069 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11070 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11071 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11072 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11073 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11074 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11075 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
11076 See also the "accept-proxy" and "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind"
11077 keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011078
11079 Supported in default-server: No
11080
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011081send-proxy-v2
11082 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11083 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11084 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11085 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11086 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
11087 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
11088 option of the "bind" keyword.
11089
11090 Supported in default-server: No
11091
11092send-proxy-v2-ssl
11093 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11094 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11095 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11096 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11097 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11098 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11099 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
11100 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11101
11102 Supported in default-server: No
11103
11104send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11105 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11106 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11107 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11108 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11109 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11110 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11111 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11112 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
11113 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11114
11115 Supported in default-server: No
11116
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011117slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011118 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11119 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11120 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11121 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11122 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11123 parameters :
11124
11125 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11126 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11127
11128 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11129 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11130 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11131 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11132
11133 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11134 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11135 seen as failed.
11136
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011137 Supported in default-server: Yes
11138
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011139sni <expression>
11140 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11141 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11142 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11143 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11144 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11145
11146 Supported in default-server: no
11147
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011148source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011149source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011150source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011151 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11152 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11153 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11154 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11155
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011156 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11157 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11158 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11159 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11160 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11161 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11162 server.
11163
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011164 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11165 specifying the source address without port(s).
11166
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011167 Supported in default-server: No
11168
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011169ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011170 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11171 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11172 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11173 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11174 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11175 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011176 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011177
11178 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011179
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011180tcp-ut <delay>
11181 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11182 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11183 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
11184 acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
11185 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11186 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11187 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11188 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11189 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11190 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11191 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11192 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11193 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011195track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011196 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11197 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11198 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11199 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011200 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11201
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011202 Supported in default-server: No
11203
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011204verify [none|required]
11205 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011206 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11207 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11208 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11209 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011210 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11211 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11212 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011213
11214 Supported in default-server: No
11215
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011216verifyhost <hostname>
11217 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11218 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11219 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11220 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11221 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11222 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
11223
11224 Supported in default-server: No
11225
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011226weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011227 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11228 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11229 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011230 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11231 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11232 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11233 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11234 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11235 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011236
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011237 Supported in default-server: Yes
11238
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011239
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200112405.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11241-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011242
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011243HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11244using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11245configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011246This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11247can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11248workload.
11249This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11250resolution at run time.
11251Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11252carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11253
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011254Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11255health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11256
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011257
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200112585.3.1. Global overview
11259----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011260
11261As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11262different steps of the process life:
11263
11264 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11265 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11266 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11267
11268 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11269 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11270 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11271
11272A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11273 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11274 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11275 resolution to know this new IP.
11276
11277A few things important to notice:
11278 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11279 first valid response.
11280
11281 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11282 servers return an error.
11283
11284
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200112855.3.2. The resolvers section
11286----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011287
11288This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11289HAProxy.
11290There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11291many name servers.
11292
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011293When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11294uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11295is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11296answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11297
11298When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11299used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11300
11301Two types of behavior can be applied:
11302 1. stop DNS resolution
11303 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11304 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11305 1. ANY query type
11306 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11307 server's parameter
11308 3. remaining family type
11309
11310HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11311 - invalid DNS response packet
11312 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11313 - NX domain
11314 - Query refused by server
11315 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11316
11317HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11318 - no Answer records in the response
11319 - DNS response truncated
11320 - Error in DNS response
11321 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11322 - name server timeout
11323
11324For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11325 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11326 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11327 applied;
11328 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11329 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11330 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11331 stops resolution.
11332
11333
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011334resolvers <resolvers id>
11335 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11336
11337A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11338
11339nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11340 DNS server description:
11341 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11342 <ip> : IP address of the server
11343 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11344
11345hold <status> <period>
11346 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11347 on last resolution <status>
11348 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
11349 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11350 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11351 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11352
11353 Default value is 10s for "valid".
11354
11355 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11356 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11357 the healch check.
11358
11359resolve_retries <nb>
11360 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11361 giving up.
11362 Default value: 3
11363
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011364 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11365 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11366 type.
11367
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011368timeout <event> <time>
11369 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11370 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11371 events available are:
11372 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11373 been received.
11374 Default value: 1s
11375 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11376 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11377
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011378 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011379
11380 resolvers mydns
11381 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11382 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11383 resolve_retries 3
11384 timeout retry 1s
11385 hold valid 10s
11386
11387
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113886. HTTP header manipulation
11389---------------------------
11390
11391In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11392response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11393request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11394which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011395against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011396
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011397If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11398to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11399but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11400HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11401stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11402because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11403a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11404still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011406This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11407in section 4.2 :
11408
11409 - reqadd <string>
11410 - reqallow <search>
11411 - reqiallow <search>
11412 - reqdel <search>
11413 - reqidel <search>
11414 - reqdeny <search>
11415 - reqideny <search>
11416 - reqpass <search>
11417 - reqipass <search>
11418 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11419 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11420 - reqtarpit <search>
11421 - reqitarpit <search>
11422 - rspadd <string>
11423 - rspdel <search>
11424 - rspidel <search>
11425 - rspdeny <search>
11426 - rspideny <search>
11427 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11428 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11429
11430With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11431is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11432parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11433prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11434Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11435
11436 \t for a tab
11437 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11438 \n for a new line (LF)
11439 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11440 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11441 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11442 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11443 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11444
11445The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11446portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11447above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11448regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
114499 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11450is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11451
11452The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11453after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11454
11455Notes related to these keywords :
11456---------------------------------
11457 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11458 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11459 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11460
11461 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11462 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11463 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11464
11465 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11466 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11467 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11468 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11469 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11470
11471 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11472 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11473 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11474 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11475 useless headers before adding new ones.
11476
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011477 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011478 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11479
11480 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11481 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11482 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11483
11484 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11485 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011486 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011487
11488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114897. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11490----------------------------------
11491
11492Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11493client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11494The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11495these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11496but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11497data called patterns.
11498
11499
115007.1. ACL basics
11501---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011502
11503The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11504content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11505from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11506simple :
11507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011508 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011509 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011510 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11511 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011513The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11514adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011515
11516In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011518 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011519
11520This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11521Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11522and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011523an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11524conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11525as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11526are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011527
11528ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11529'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11530which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11531
11532There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11533performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011535The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11536specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11537this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011538methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11539ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011540
11541Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11542 - boolean
11543 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11544 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11545 - string
11546 - data block
11547
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011548Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11549converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11550would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11551The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11552which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11553
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011554Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11555keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11556fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11557which are summarized in the table below :
11558
11559 +---------------------+-----------------+
11560 | Sample or converter | Default |
11561 | output type | matching method |
11562 +---------------------+-----------------+
11563 | boolean | bool |
11564 +---------------------+-----------------+
11565 | integer | int |
11566 +---------------------+-----------------+
11567 | ip | ip |
11568 +---------------------+-----------------+
11569 | string | str |
11570 +---------------------+-----------------+
11571 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11572 +---------------------+-----------------+
11573
11574Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11575matching method, see below.
11576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011577The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11578 - boolean
11579 - integer or integer range
11580 - IP address / network
11581 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11582 - regular expression
11583 - hex block
11584
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011585The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11586
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011587 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11588 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011589 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011590 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011591 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011592 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011593 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011595The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11596read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11597if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11598lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11599will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11600beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11601a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11602lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11603exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11604
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011605The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11606parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11607ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11608a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11609check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11610
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011611The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11612socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11613file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011615Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11616loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11617
11618 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11619
11620In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11621the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11622case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11623as well.
11624
11625The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11626sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11627do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11628methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11629is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11630obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11631followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11632default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11633that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11634string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11635
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011636The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11637By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11638string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11639resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11640server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11641waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11642flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11643function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011645There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11646sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11647be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011648
11649 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11650 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011651 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11652 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11653 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11654 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011655
11656 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11657 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011658 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011659
11660 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011661 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011662
11663 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011664 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011665
11666 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11667 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11668
11669 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11670 binary or string samples.
11671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011672 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11673 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011675 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11676 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11677 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011679 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11680 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011682 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11683 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011685 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11686 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011688 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11689 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011690 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011692 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11693 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11694 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011695
11696For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11697request, it is possible to do :
11698
11699 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11700
11701In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11702buffer, one would use the following acl :
11703
11704 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11705
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011706On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11707possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11708
11709 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011711All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11712criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11713method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11714to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11715criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11716the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011718If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011719the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11720For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011722 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11723 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11724 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11725 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011726
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011727
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011728The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11729types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11730combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11731brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11732default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011734 +-------------------------------------------------+
11735 | Input sample type |
11736 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011737 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011738 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11739 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11740 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011741 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011742 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011743 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011744 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011745 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011746 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011747 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011748 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011749 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011750 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011751 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011752 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011753 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011754 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011755 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011756 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011757 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011758 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011759 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011760 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011761 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011762 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11763 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11764 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011765
11766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117677.1.1. Matching booleans
11768------------------------
11769
11770In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11771Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11772When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11773that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11774
11775Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11776return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11777"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11778
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117807.1.2. Matching integers
11781------------------------
11782
11783Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11784enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11785to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11786
11787Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11788matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11789lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011790
11791For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11792unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11793representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11794
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011795As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11796two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11797instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11798ranges and operators.
11799
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011800For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011801operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11802Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11803of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011804
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011805Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011806
11807 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11808 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11809 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11810 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11811 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11812
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011813For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011814
11815 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11816
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011817This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11818
11819 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11820
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200118227.1.3. Matching strings
11823-----------------------
11824
11825String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11826different forms :
11827
11828 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11829 patterns ;
11830
11831 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11832 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11833
11834 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11835 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11836
11837 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11838 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11839
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010011840 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011841 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11842 matches.
11843
11844 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11845 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11846 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011847
11848String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11849exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11850characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11851string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11852to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011853before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011854
11855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200118567.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11857---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011858
11859Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11860they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11861possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11862passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11863the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011864the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11865match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011866
11867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200118687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11869-------------------------------------
11870
11871It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11872not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11873a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11874to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11875digits may be used upper or lower case.
11876
11877Example :
11878 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11879 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11880
11881
118827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11883---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011884
11885IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11886netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11887within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011888host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011889difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11890at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11891does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11892parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011893
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020011894The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
11895abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
11896
11897 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11898 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
11899 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11900 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
11901 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
11902 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
11903 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
11904 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11905
11906Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
11907192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
11908
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011909IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
11910Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
11911trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
11912IPv6 patterns.
11913
11914HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
11915following situations :
11916 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
11917 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
11918 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
11919 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
11920 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
11921 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
11922 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11923 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11924 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11925 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011927
119287.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11929----------------------------------
11930
11931Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11932combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11933
11934 - AND (implicit)
11935 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11936 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011938A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011940 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011942Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11943indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011945For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11946"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11947requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11948is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11949
11950 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11951 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11952 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11953 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11954
11955To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11956and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11957
11958 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11959 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11960 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11961 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11962
11963 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11964 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11965 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11966 use_backend www if host_www
11967
11968It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11969expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11970be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11971the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11972
11973 The following rule :
11974
11975 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11976 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11977
11978 Can also be written that way :
11979
11980 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11981
11982It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11983to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11984simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11985sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11986good use is the following :
11987
11988 With named ACLs :
11989
11990 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11991 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11992 monitor fail if site_dead
11993
11994 With anonymous ACLs :
11995
11996 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
11997
11998See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
11999
12000
120017.3. Fetching samples
12002---------------------
12003
12004Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12005against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12006sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12007ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12008of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12009available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12010
12011This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12012Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12013compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12014deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12015
12016The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12017matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12018method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12019indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12020
12021As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12022when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12023mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12024the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12025ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12026
12027Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12028multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12029when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12030incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12031are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12032is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12033all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12034
12035Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12036 - name
12037 - name(arg1)
12038 - name(arg1,arg2)
12039
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012040
120417.3.1. Converters
12042-----------------
12043
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012044Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12045of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12046is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12047was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12048has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12049unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12050
12051These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12052sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12053the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12054support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012055
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012056A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12057support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12058supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12059(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12060bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012062The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012063
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012064add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012065 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012066 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012067 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12068 scopes allowed are:
12069 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12070 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12071 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12072 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12073 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012074 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012075
12076and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012077 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012078 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012079 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12080 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12081 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12082 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12083 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12084 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12085 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012086 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012087
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012088base64
12089 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12090 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12091 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12092
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012093bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012094 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012095 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12096 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12097 presence of a flag).
12098
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012099bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12100 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12101 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
12102 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
12103
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012104cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012105 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12106 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012107
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012108crc32([<avalanche>])
12109 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12110 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12111 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12112 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12113 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12114 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12115 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12116 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12117 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12118 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12119 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12120
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012121da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012122 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12123 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12124 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12125 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012126 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012127 configuration language.
12128
12129 Example:
12130 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012131 bind *:8881
12132 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012133 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012134
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012135debug
12136 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12137 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12138 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12139
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012140div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012141 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12142 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012143 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012144 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12145 scope. The scopes allowed are:
12146 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12147 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12148 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12149 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12150 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012151 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012152
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012153djb2([<avalanche>])
12154 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12155 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12156 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12157 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12158 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12159 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12160 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012161 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12162 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012163
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012164even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012165 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012166 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12167
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012168field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12169 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12170 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12171 list of chars.
12172
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012173hex
12174 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12175 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12176 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12177 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012178
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012179http_date([<offset>])
12180 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12181 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12182 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12183 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12184 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12185 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012186
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012187in_table(<table>)
12188 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12189 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12190 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12191 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12192 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12193
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012194ipmask(<mask>)
12195 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12196 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12197 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12198 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12199
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012200json([<input-code>])
12201 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12202 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012203 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012204 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12205 of errors:
12206 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12207 bytes, ...)
12208 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12209 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12210
12211 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12212 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12213 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12214 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12215 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12216 are :
12217 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12218 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12219 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12220 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12221 error ;
12222 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12223 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12224
12225 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12226 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12227
12228 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012229 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012230 capture request header user-agent len 150
12231 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012232
12233 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12234 GET / HTTP/1.0
12235 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12236
12237 Output log:
12238 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12239
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012240language(<value>[,<default>])
12241 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12242 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12243 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12244 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12245 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12246 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12247 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12248 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12249 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12250 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12251 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12252 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012253
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012254 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012255
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012256 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12257 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012258
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012259 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12260 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12261 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12262 use_backend spanish if es
12263 use_backend french if fr
12264 use_backend english if en
12265 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012266
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012267lower
12268 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12269 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12270 type. The result is of type string.
12271
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012272ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12273 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12274 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12275 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12276 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12277 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12278 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12279
12280 Example :
12281
12282 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12283 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12284 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12285
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012286map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12287map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12288map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12289 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12290 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12291 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12292 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12293 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12294 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12295 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12296 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012297
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012298 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12299 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12300 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012301
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012302 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
12303 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012304
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012305 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12306 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12307 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12308 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012309 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12310 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012311 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12312 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12313 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12314 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12315 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12316 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12317 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12318 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012319 | | map_reg | |
12320 str | reg +-----------------+ map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12321 | | map_regm | |
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012322 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12323 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12324 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12325 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12326 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012327
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012328 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12329 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12330 the corresponding match text.
12331
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012332 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12333 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12334 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12335 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12336 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012337
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012338 Example :
12339
12340 # this is a comment and is ignored
12341 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12342 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12343 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12344 | | | `---------- value
12345 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12346 | `---------------------------- key
12347 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12348
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012349mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012350 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12351 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012352 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012353 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12354 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12355 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12356 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12357 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12358 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012359 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012360
12361mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012362 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012363 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12364 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012365 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012366 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12367 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12368 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12369 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12370 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12371 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012372 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012373
12374neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012375 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12376 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12377 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12378 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012379
12380not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012381 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012382 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12383 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12384 absence of a flag).
12385
12386odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012387 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012388 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12389
12390or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012391 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012392 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012393 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12394 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12395 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12396 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12397 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12398 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12399 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012400 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012401
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012402regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012403 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12404 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12405 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12406 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12407 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12408 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12409 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12410 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12411 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12412 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012413 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12414 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12415 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12416 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012417
12418 Example :
12419
12420 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12421 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12422 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12423 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12424
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012425capture-req(<id>)
12426 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12427 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12428
12429 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012430 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12431 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012432
12433capture-res(<id>)
12434 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12435 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12436
12437 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012438 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12439 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012440
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012441sdbm([<avalanche>])
12442 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12443 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12444 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12445 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12446 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12447 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12448 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012449 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12450 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012451
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012452set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012453 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12454 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12455 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12456 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12457 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012458 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012459 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12460 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012461 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12462 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12463
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012464sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012465 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12466 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012467 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012468 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12469 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12470 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12471 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012472 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012473 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12474 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012475 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12476 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012477
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012478table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12479 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12480 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12481 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12482 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12483 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12484 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12485
12486
12487table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12488 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12489 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12490 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12491 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12492 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12493 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12494
12495table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12496 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12497 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12498 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12499 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12500 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12501
12502table_conn_cur(<table>)
12503 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12504 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12505 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12506 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12507 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12508
12509table_conn_rate(<table>)
12510 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12511 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12512 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12513 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12514 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12515
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012516table_gpt0(<table>)
12517 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12518 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12519 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12520 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12521 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12522
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012523table_gpc0(<table>)
12524 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12525 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12526 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12527 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12528 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12529
12530table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12531 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12532 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12533 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12534 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12535 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12536 sample fetch keyword.
12537
12538table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12539 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12540 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12541 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12542 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12543 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12544
12545table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12546 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12547 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12548 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12549 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12550 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12551 keyword.
12552
12553table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12554 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12555 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12556 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12557 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12558 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12559
12560table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12561 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12562 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12563 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12564 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12565 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12566 keyword.
12567
12568table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12569 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12570 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12571 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12572 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12573 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12574 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12575 keyword.
12576
12577table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12578 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12579 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12580 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12581 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12582 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12583 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12584 keyword.
12585
12586table_server_id(<table>)
12587 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12588 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12589 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12590 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12591 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12592 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12593
12594table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12595 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12596 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12597 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12598 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12599 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12600 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12601 keyword.
12602
12603table_sess_rate(<table>)
12604 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12605 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12606 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12607 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12608 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12609 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12610 keyword.
12611
12612table_trackers(<table>)
12613 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12614 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12615 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12616 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12617 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12618 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12619 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12620 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12621 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12622 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12623
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012624upper
12625 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12626 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12627 type. The result is of type string.
12628
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012629url_dec
12630 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12631 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12632
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012633utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12634 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12635 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12636 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12637 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12638 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12639 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12640
12641 Example :
12642
12643 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12644 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12645 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12646
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012647word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12648 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12649 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12650
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012651wt6([<avalanche>])
12652 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12653 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12654 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12655 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12656 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12657 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12658 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012659 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12660 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012661
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012662xor(<value>)
12663 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012664 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012665 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012666 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12667 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12668 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012669 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012670 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12671 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012672 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12673 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012674
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012675
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200126767.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012677--------------------------------------------
12678
12679A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12680not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12681"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12682The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12683
12684always_false : boolean
12685 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12686 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12687
12688always_true : boolean
12689 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12690 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12691
12692avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012693 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012694 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12695 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12696 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12697 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12698 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12699 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12700 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12701 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12702 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12703 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12704 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12705 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12706 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012708be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012709 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12710 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12711 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12712 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12713 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012715be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12716 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12717 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12718 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12719 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12720 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12721 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012722
12723 Example :
12724 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12725 backend dynamic
12726 mode http
12727 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12728 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012729
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012730bin(<hexa>) : bin
12731 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12732 of the string.
12733
12734bool(<bool>) : bool
12735 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12736 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012738connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12739 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012740 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012741 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12742 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012743
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012744 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012745 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012746 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12747
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012748 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12749 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012750
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012751 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012752 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012753 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012754 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12755 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012756 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012757 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012758
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012759 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12760 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012761 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012762 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012763
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012764date([<offset>]) : integer
12765 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12766 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12767 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12768 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012769 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12770
12771 Example :
12772
12773 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12774 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012775
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012776env(<name>) : string
12777 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12778 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12779 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12780 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12781 certain way.
12782
12783 Examples :
12784 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12785 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12786
12787 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12788 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012790fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12791 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012792 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12793 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012794 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12795 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12796 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12797 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12798 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012799
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020012800fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12801 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
12802 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
12803 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
12804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012805fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12806 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12807 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12808 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12809 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12810 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12811 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12812 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12813 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012814
12815 Example :
12816 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12817 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12818 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12819 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12820 frontend mail
12821 bind :25
12822 mode tcp
12823 maxconn 100
12824 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12825 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12826 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12827 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012828
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012829int(<integer>) : signed integer
12830 Returns a signed integer.
12831
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012832ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12833 Returns an ipv4.
12834
12835ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12836 Returns an ipv6.
12837
12838meth(<method>) : method
12839 Returns a method.
12840
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012841nbproc : integer
12842 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12843 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12844 and debugging purposes.
12845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012846nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
12847 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
12848 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
12849 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012850 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
12851 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
12852 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012853
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012854proc : integer
12855 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
12856 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
12857 debugging purposes.
12858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012859queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012860 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
12861 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
12862 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012863 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
12864 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
12865 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
12866 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
12867 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
12868
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010012869rand([<range>]) : integer
12870 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
12871 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
12872 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
12873 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
12874 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
12875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012876srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12877 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12878 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
12879 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
12880 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
12881 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
12882 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
12883 methods.
12884
12885srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
12886 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
12887 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
12888 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
12889 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
12890 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
12891 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
12892 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
12893
12894srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12895 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12896 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012897 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012898 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
12899 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
12900 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
12901 overloading servers).
12902
12903 Example :
12904 # Redirect to a separate back
12905 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
12906 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
12907 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
12908
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012909stopping : boolean
12910 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
12911 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
12912 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
12913
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012914str(<string>) : string
12915 Returns a string.
12916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012917table_avl([<table>]) : integer
12918 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
12919 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
12920
12921table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12922 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
12923 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
12924 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
12925
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012926var(<var-name>) : undefined
12927 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012928 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
12929 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12930 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12931 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012932 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012933 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12934 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012935 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12936 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12937
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200129387.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012939----------------------------------
12940
12941The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12942closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12943methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12944sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12945TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012946the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12947counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12948"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012949argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12950the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12951this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012952
12953be_id : integer
12954 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12955 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12956
12957dst : ip
12958 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12959 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12960 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12961 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12962 RFC 4291.
12963
12964dst_conn : integer
12965 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12966 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12967 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12968 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12969 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12970 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12971 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12972 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012973
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020012974dst_is_local : boolean
12975 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
12976 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
12977 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
12978 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
12979 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
12980 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
12981 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
12982 it only once per connection.
12983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012984dst_port : integer
12985 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12986 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12987 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12988 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12989 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12990 an HTTP header.
12991
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020012992fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
12993 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
12994 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
12995 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
12996 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
12997 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
12998 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12999
13000fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13001 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13002 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13003 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13004 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13005 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13006 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13007
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013008fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13009 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13010 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13011 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13012 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13013
13014fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13015 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13016 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13017 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13018 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13019
13020fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13021 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13022 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13023 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13024 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13025
13026fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13027 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13028 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13029 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13030 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13031
13032fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13033 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13034 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13035 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13036 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13037
13038fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13039 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13040 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13041 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13042 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013044fe_id : integer
13045 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
13046 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
13047 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13048
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013049sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013050sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13051sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13052sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013053 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13054 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13055 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13056
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013057sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013058sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13059sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13060sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013061 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13062 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13063 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13064
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013065sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013066sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13067sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13068sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013069 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13070 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013071 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13072 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13073 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013074
13075 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13076 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013077 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13078 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13079 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013080 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13081 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13082
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013083sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013084sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13085sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13086sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013087 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13088 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13089
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013090sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013091sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13092sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13093sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013094 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13095 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13096 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13097
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013098sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013099sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13100sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13101sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013102 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13103 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13104 See also src_conn_rate.
13105
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013106sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013107sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13108sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13109sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013110 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013111 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013112
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013113sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13114sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13115sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13116sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13117 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13118 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13119
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013120sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013121sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13122sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13123sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013124 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13125 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13126 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013127 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13128 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13129 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013130
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013131sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013132sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13133sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13134sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013135 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13136 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13137 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13138
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013139sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013140sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13141sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13142sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013143 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13144 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13145 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13146 src_http_err_rate.
13147
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013148sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013149sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13150sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13151sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013152 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13153 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13154 src_http_req_cnt.
13155
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013156sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013157sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13158sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13159sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013160 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13161 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13162 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13163 src_http_req_rate.
13164
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013165sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013166sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13167sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13168sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013169 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013170 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13171 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13172 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13173 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013174
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013175 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13176 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013177 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13178
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013179sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013180sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13181sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13182sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013183 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13184 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13185 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013186
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013187sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013188sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13189sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13190sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013191 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13192 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13193 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013194
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013195sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013196sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13197sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13198sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013199 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13200 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13201 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13202 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013203 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013204 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13205
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013206sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013207sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13208sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13209sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013210 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13211 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13212 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13213 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13214 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013215 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013216
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013217sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013218sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13219sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13220sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013221 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13222 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13223 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13224
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013225sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013226sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13227sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13228sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013229 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13230 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013231 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013232 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13233 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013234 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13235 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13236 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013238so_id : integer
13239 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13240 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13241 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013243src : ip
13244 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13245 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13246 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13247 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013248 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13249 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13250 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13251 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013252
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013253 Example:
13254 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13255 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013257src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13258 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13259 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13260 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013261 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013263src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13264 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13265 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013266 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013267 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013269src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13270 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13271 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13272 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13273 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13274 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13275 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013276
13277 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13278 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13279 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13280 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013281 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013282 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13283 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013285src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013286 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013287 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013288 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013289 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013291src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013292 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013293 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13294 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013295 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013297src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13298 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13299 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13300 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013301 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013303src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013304 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013305 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013306 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013307 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013308
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013309src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13310 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13311 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13312 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13313 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013315src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013316 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013317 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013318 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13319 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013320 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13321 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13322 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013324src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13325 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13326 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013327 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013328 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013329 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013331src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13332 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13333 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13334 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13335 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013336 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013338src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13339 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13340 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13341 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013342 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013344src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13345 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13346 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13347 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013348 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013349 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013351src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13352 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13353 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13354 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013355 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013356 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13357 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013358
13359 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013360 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013361 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013362
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013363src_is_local : boolean
13364 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13365 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13366 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13367 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13368 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13369 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13370 once per connection.
13371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013372src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013373 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13374 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13375 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13376 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13377 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013379src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013380 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13381 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13382 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13383 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13384 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013386src_port : integer
13387 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13388 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13389 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13390 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013392src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13393 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013394 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13395 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13396 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013397 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013399src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13400 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13401 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13402 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13403 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013404 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013406src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13407 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13408 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13409 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13410 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13411 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13412 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13413 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13414 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013415
13416 Example :
13417 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13418 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13419 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13420 listen ssh
13421 bind :22
13422 mode tcp
13423 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013424 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013425 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013426 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013428srv_id : integer
13429 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13430 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13431 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013432
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200134337.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013434----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013436The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13437closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13438when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13439usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013440future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013441
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013442ssl_bc : boolean
13443 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13444 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13445 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13446
13447ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13448 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13449 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13450
13451ssl_bc_cipher : string
13452 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13453 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13454
13455ssl_bc_protocol : string
13456 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13457 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13458
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013459ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013460 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013461 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13462 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013463
13464ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13465 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13466 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13467 if session was reused or not.
13468
13469ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13470 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13471 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013473ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13474 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13475 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13476 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13477 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13478 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013480ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13481 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13482 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13483 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13484 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013485
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013486ssl_c_der : binary
13487 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13488 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13489 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013491ssl_c_err : integer
13492 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13493 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13494 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13495 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13496 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013498ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13499 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13500 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13501 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13502 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13503 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13504 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13505 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13506 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013508ssl_c_key_alg : string
13509 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13510 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13511 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013513ssl_c_notafter : string
13514 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13515 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13516 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013518ssl_c_notbefore : string
13519 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13520 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13521 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013523ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13524 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13525 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13526 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13527 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13528 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13529 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13530 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13531 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013533ssl_c_serial : binary
13534 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13535 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13536 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013538ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13539 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13540 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13541 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013542 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13543 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13544
13545 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013547ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13548 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13549 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13550 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013552ssl_c_used : boolean
13553 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13554 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013556ssl_c_verify : integer
13557 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13558 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13559 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13560 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013562ssl_c_version : integer
13563 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13564 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013565
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013566ssl_f_der : binary
13567 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13568 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13569 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013571ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13572 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13573 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13574 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13575 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013576 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013577 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13578 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13579 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013581ssl_f_key_alg : string
13582 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13583 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13584 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013586ssl_f_notafter : string
13587 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13588 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13589 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013591ssl_f_notbefore : string
13592 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13593 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13594 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013596ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13597 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13598 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13599 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13600 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13601 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13602 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13603 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13604 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013606ssl_f_serial : binary
13607 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13608 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13609 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013610
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013611ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13612 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13613 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13614 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013616ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13617 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13618 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13619 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013621ssl_f_version : integer
13622 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13623 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13624
13625ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013626 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13627 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13628 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013630 Example :
13631 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13632 listen http-https
13633 bind :80
13634 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13635 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13636
13637ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13638 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13639 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13640
13641ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013642 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013643 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13644 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13645 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13646 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13647 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13648 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13649 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13650 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013652ssl_fc_cipher : string
13653 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13654 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013656ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013657 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13658 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013659 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13660 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13661 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13662 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013664ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13665 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013666 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13667 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13668 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13669 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013670
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020013671ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013672 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13673 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013675ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013676 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013677 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13678 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13679 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13680 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13681 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13682 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13683 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013685ssl_fc_protocol : string
13686 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13687 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013688
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013689ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013690 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013691 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13692 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013694ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13695 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13696 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13697 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13698 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013700ssl_fc_sni : string
13701 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13702 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13703 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13704 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13705 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13706
13707 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13708 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13709 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013710 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13711 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013713 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013714 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13715 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013717ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13718 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13719 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013720
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013721
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200137227.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013723------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013725Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13726sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13727only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13728For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13729be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13730can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13731sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13732for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13733content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013735payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13736 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13737 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13738 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013740payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13741 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13742 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13743 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013745req.len : integer
13746req_len : integer (deprecated)
13747 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13748 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13749 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13750 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13751 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13752 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13753 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
13754 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013756req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13757 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013758 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13759 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13760 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13761 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013763 ACL alternatives :
13764 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013766req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13767 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13768 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13769 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
13770 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013772 ACL alternatives :
13773 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013775 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013777req.proto_http : boolean
13778req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
13779 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
13780 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
13781 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
13782 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
13783 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
13784 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
13785 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013787 Example:
13788 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13789 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13790 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013791 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013793req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13794rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13795 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13796 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13797 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13798 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13799 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13800 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13801 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013803 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13804 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13805 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13806 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13807 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13808 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013810 ACL derivatives :
13811 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013813 Example :
13814 listen tse-farm
13815 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
13816 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
13817 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13818 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
13819 # apply RDP cookie persistence
13820 persist rdp-cookie
13821 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
13822 # This is only useful makes sense if
13823 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
13824 stick-table type string size 204800
13825 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
13826 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
13827 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013829 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
13830 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013832req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
13833rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
13834 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
13835 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
13836 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
13837 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013839 ACL derivatives :
13840 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013841
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013842req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
13843 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
13844 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013845 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
13846 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
13847 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
13848 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
13849 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013851req.ssl_hello_type : integer
13852req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13853 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13854 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
13855 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13856 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13857 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
13858 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13859 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013861req.ssl_sni : string
13862req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
13863 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
13864 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
13865 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
13866 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13867 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13868 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
13869 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
13870 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
13871 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
13872 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
13873 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
13874 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013876 ACL derivatives :
13877 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013879 Examples :
13880 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
13881 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13882 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
13883 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
13884 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013885
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053013886req.ssl_st_ext : integer
13887 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
13888 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
13889 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
13890 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
13891 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
13892 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
13893 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
13894 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
13895 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
13896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013897req.ssl_ver : integer
13898req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
13899 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
13900 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
13901 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
13902 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
13903 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13904 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13905 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
13906 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
13907 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013909 ACL derivatives :
13910 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013911
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020013912res.len : integer
13913 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13914 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13915 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13916 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13917 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13918 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13919 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
13920 content inspection.
13921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013922res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13923 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013924 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13925 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13926 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13927 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013929res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13930 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13931 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13932 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
13933 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013935 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013936
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020013937res.ssl_hello_type : integer
13938rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13939 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13940 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
13941 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13942 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13943 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
13944 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13945 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
13946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013947wait_end : boolean
13948 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
13949 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
13950 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
13951 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
13952 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
13953 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
13954 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
13955 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013957 Examples :
13958 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
13959 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
13960 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013962 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
13963 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13964 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
13965 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
13966 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
13967 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
13968 tcp-request content reject
13969
13970
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200139717.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013972--------------------------------------
13973
13974It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
13975This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
13976data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
13977its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
13978HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
13979content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
13980to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
13981more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
13982response are indexed.
13983
13984base : string
13985 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
13986 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
13987 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
13988 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
13989 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
13990 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
13991 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
13992 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
13993
13994 ACL derivatives :
13995 base : exact string match
13996 base_beg : prefix match
13997 base_dir : subdir match
13998 base_dom : domain match
13999 base_end : suffix match
14000 base_len : length match
14001 base_reg : regex match
14002 base_sub : substring match
14003
14004base32 : integer
14005 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14006 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14007 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014008 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14009 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14010 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014011
14012base32+src : binary
14013 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14014 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14015 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14016 per-URL counters.
14017
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014018capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14019 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14020 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14021 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14022
14023capture.req.method : string
14024 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14025 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14026 because it's allocated.
14027
14028capture.req.uri : string
14029 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14030 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14031 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14032 allocated.
14033
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014034capture.req.ver : string
14035 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14036 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14037 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14038
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014039capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14040 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14041 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14042 The first entry is an index of 0.
14043 See also: "capture response header"
14044
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014045capture.res.ver : string
14046 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14047 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14048 persistent flag.
14049
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014050req.body : binary
14051 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14052 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14053 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14054 the first chunk is analyzed.
14055
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014056req.body_param([<name>) : string
14057 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14058 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14059 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14060 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14061 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14062 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14063 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14064 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14065 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14066 given.
14067
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014068req.body_len : integer
14069 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14070 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14071 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14072 "option http-buffer-request".
14073
14074req.body_size : integer
14075 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14076 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14077 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14078 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14079 "option http-buffer-request".
14080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014081req.cook([<name>]) : string
14082cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14083 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14084 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14085 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14086 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14087 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14088 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14089 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14090 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14091
14092 ACL derivatives :
14093 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14094 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14095 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14096 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14097 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14098 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14099 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14100 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014102req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14103cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14104 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14105 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014107req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14108cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14109 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14110 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14111 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14112 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014114cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14115 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14116 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14117 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14118 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014119 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014120 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14121 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14122 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14123 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014125hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14126 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14127 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14128 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14129 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014130 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014132req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14133 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14134 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14135 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14136 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14137 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14138 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14139 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14140 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014142req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14143 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14144 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14145 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14146 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014148req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14149 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14150 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14151 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14152 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14153 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14154 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14155 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14156 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
14157 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
14158 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14159 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014161 ACL derivatives :
14162 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14163 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14164 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14165 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14166 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14167 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14168 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14169 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14170
14171req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14172hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14173 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14174 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14175 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14176 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14177 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14178 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14179 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14180 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14181 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14182
14183req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14184hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14185 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14186 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14187 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14188 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14189 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14190 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14191 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14192 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14193
14194req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14195hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14196 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14197 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14198 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14199 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14200 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14201 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14202 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14203
14204http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14205 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14206 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14207 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14208 basic auth is supported.
14209
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014210http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14211 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14212 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14213 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14214 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014215 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14216 basic auth is supported.
14217
14218 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014219 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14220 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14221 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14222 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014223
14224http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014225 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14226 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014227 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14228 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014230method : integer + string
14231 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14232 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14233 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14234 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14235 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14236 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14237 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014239 ACL derivatives :
14240 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014242 Example :
14243 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14244 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14245 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014247path : string
14248 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14249 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14250 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14251 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14252 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14253 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14254 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014256 ACL derivatives :
14257 path : exact string match
14258 path_beg : prefix match
14259 path_dir : subdir match
14260 path_dom : domain match
14261 path_end : suffix match
14262 path_len : length match
14263 path_reg : regex match
14264 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014265
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014266query : string
14267 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14268 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14269 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14270 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
14271 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
14272 which stops before the question mark.
14273
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014274req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14275 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14276 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14277 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14278 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014280req.ver : string
14281req_ver : string (deprecated)
14282 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14283 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14284 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014286 ACL derivatives :
14287 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014289res.comp : boolean
14290 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14291 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14292 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014294res.comp_algo : string
14295 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14296 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14297 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014299res.cook([<name>]) : string
14300scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14301 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14302 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14303 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014305 ACL derivatives :
14306 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014308res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14309scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14310 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14311 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14312 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014314res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14315scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14316 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14317 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14318 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014320res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14321 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14322 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14323 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14324 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14325 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14326 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14327 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14328 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14329 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014331res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14332 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14333 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14334 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14335 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14336 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014338res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14339shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14340 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14341 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14342 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14343 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14344 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14345 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14346 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14347 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014349 ACL derivatives :
14350 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14351 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14352 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14353 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14354 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14355 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14356 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14357 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14358
14359res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14360shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14361 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14362 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14363 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14364 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14365 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014367res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14368shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14369 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14370 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14371 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14372 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14373 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14374 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014375
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014376res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14377 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14378 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14379 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14380 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014382res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14383shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14384 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14385 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14386 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14387 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14388 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14389 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014391res.ver : string
14392resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14393 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14394 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014396 ACL derivatives :
14397 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014399set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14400 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14401 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014402 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014403 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014405 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14406 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014408status : integer
14409 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14410 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14411 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014412
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014413unique-id : string
14414 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14415 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14416 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14417 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14418 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14419 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014421url : string
14422 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14423 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14424 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14425 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14426 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14427 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14428 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014430 ACL derivatives :
14431 url : exact string match
14432 url_beg : prefix match
14433 url_dir : subdir match
14434 url_dom : domain match
14435 url_end : suffix match
14436 url_len : length match
14437 url_reg : regex match
14438 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014440url_ip : ip
14441 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14442 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14443 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14444 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14445 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14446 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14447 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014449url_port : integer
14450 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14451 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14452 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14453 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014454
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014455urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14456url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014457 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14458 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014459 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14460 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14461 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14462 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014463 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14464 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014465 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14466 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014468 ACL derivatives :
14469 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14470 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14471 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14472 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14473 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14474 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14475 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14476 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014477
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014479 Example :
14480 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14481 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14482 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14483 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014484
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014485urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014486 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14487 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14488 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014489
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014490url32 : integer
14491 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14492 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14493 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14494 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14495 is an unsigned integer.
14496
14497url32+src : binary
14498 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14499 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14500 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14501
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200145037.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014504---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014506Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14507every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014508order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014510ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14511---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014512FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014513HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014514HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14515HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014516HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14517HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14518HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14519HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14520LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014521METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014522METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014523METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14524METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14525METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14526METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014527METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014528METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014529RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014530REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014531TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014532WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14533---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014534
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014535
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145368. Logging
14537----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014538
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014539One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14540provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14541very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14542provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14543state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014544to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014545headers.
14546
14547In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14548about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14549send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14550
14551 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14552 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14553 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14554 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14555 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014556 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14557 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014558
14559The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14560allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14561as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14562while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14563real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14564delay.
14565
14566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145678.1. Log levels
14568---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014569
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014570TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014571source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014572HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14573in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14574track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14575syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14576about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014577
14578
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145798.2. Log formats
14580----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014581
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014582HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014583and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14584slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14585options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014586
14587 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14588 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14589 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14590 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14591 extents.
14592
14593 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14594 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14595 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14596 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14597 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14598
14599 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14600 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14601 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14602 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14603 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14604
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014605 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14606 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14607 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14608 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14609
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014610 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14611
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014612Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14613specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14614field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14615servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14616always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14617identifier.
14618
14619Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14620 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14621 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14622 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14623 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14624
14625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146268.2.1. Default log format
14627-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014628
14629This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14630as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14631format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14632
14633 Example :
14634 listen www
14635 mode http
14636 log global
14637 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14638
14639 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14640 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14641 (www/HTTP)
14642
14643 Field Format Extract from the example above
14644 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14645 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14646 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14647 4 'to' to
14648 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14649 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14650
14651Detailed fields description :
14652 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14653 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14654 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14655 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14656 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14657 and processed the connection.
14658 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14659
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014660In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14661"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14662connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14663
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014664It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14665will eventually disappear.
14666
14667
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146688.2.2. TCP log format
14669---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014670
14671The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14672is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14673information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14674counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14675emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14676environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14677the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14678sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014679specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14680not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14681fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14682marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014683
14684 Example :
14685 frontend fnt
14686 mode tcp
14687 option tcplog
14688 log global
14689 default_backend bck
14690
14691 backend bck
14692 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14693
14694 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14695 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14696 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14697
14698 Field Format Extract from the example above
14699 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14700 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14701 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14702 4 frontend_name fnt
14703 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14704 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14705 7 bytes_read* 212
14706 8 termination_state --
14707 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14708 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14709
14710Detailed fields description :
14711 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014712 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14713 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14714 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014715 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14716 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14717 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014718
14719 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014720 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14721 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14722 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014723
14724 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14725 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14726 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14727 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14728
14729 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14730 and processed the connection.
14731
14732 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14733 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14734 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14735 applications.
14736
14737 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14738 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14739 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14740 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14741 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14742
14743 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14744 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14745 See "Timers" below for more details.
14746
14747 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14748 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14749 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
14750 "Timers" below for more details.
14751
14752 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014753 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014754 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14755 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14756 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14757 details.
14758
14759 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
14760 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
14761 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
14762 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
14763 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
14764
14765 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14766 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14767 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
14768 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
14769 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
14770 for more details.
14771
14772 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014773 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014774 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
14775 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
14776 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014777 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014778
14779 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14780 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14781 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14782 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14783 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14784 caused by a denial of service attack.
14785
14786 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14787 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14788 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14789 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14790 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14791 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14792 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14793 denial of service attack.
14794
14795 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14796 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14797 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14798 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14799 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14800 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14801 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14802 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
14803 be processed than on other servers.
14804
14805 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14806 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14807 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14808 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14809 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14810 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14811 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14812 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14813 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14814 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14815 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14816 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14817 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14818
14819 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14820 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14821 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14822 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14823 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14824 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14825 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14826 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14827
14828 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14829 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14830 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14831 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14832 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14833 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14834 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14835 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14836 occurs.
14837
14838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148398.2.3. HTTP log format
14840----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014841
14842The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
14843is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
14844the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
14845are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
14846emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
14847generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
14848"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
14849which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014850frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
14851is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014852
14853Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
14854slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
14855with a star ('*') after the field name below.
14856
14857 Example :
14858 frontend http-in
14859 mode http
14860 option httplog
14861 log global
14862 default_backend bck
14863
14864 backend static
14865 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14866
14867 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
14868 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
14869 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014870 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014871
14872 Field Format Extract from the example above
14873 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
14874 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014875 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014876 4 frontend_name http-in
14877 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014878 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014879 7 status_code 200
14880 8 bytes_read* 2750
14881 9 captured_request_cookie -
14882 10 captured_response_cookie -
14883 11 termination_state ----
14884 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
14885 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14886 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
14887 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
14888 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014889
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014890Detailed fields description :
14891 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014892 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14893 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14894 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014895 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14896 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14897 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014898
14899 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014900 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14901 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14902 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014903
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014904 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
14905 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014906
14907 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14908 and processed the connection.
14909
14910 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14911 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14912 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
14913
14914 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14915 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14916 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14917 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
14918 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
14919 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
14920
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014921 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
14922 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
14923 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
14924 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
14925 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
14926 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
14927 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014928
14929 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14930 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14931 See "Timers" below for more details.
14932
14933 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14934 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14935 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
14936 below for more details.
14937
14938 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
14939 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
14940 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
14941 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
14942 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
14943 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
14944 for more details.
14945
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014946 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
14947 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
14948 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
14949 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
14950 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
14951 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
14952 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
14953 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014954
14955 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
14956 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
14957 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
14958
14959 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
14960 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
14961 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
14962 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
14963 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
14964 overflowing.
14965
14966 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
14967 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
14968 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
14969 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
14970 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
14971 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
14972 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
14973 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14974
14975 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
14976 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
14977 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
14978 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
14979 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
14980 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
14981 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
14982 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14983
14984 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14985 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14986 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
14987 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
14988 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
14989 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
14990 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
14991
14992 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014993 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014994 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
14995 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
14996 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014997 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014998 system.
14999
15000 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15001 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15002 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15003 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15004 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15005 caused by a denial of service attack.
15006
15007 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15008 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15009 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15010 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15011 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15012 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15013 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15014 denial of service attack.
15015
15016 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15017 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15018 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15019 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15020 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15021 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15022 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15023 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15024 processed than on other servers.
15025
15026 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15027 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15028 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15029 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15030 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15031 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15032 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15033 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15034 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15035 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15036 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15037 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15038 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15039
15040 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15041 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15042 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15043 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15044 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15045 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15046 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15047 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15048
15049 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15050 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15051 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15052 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15053 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15054 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15055 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15056 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15057 occurs.
15058
15059 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15060 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15061 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15062 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15063 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15064 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15065 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15066 cookies" below for more details.
15067
15068 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15069 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15070 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15071 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15072 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15073 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15074 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15075 and cookies" below for more details.
15076
15077 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15078 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15079 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15080 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15081 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15082 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15083 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15084 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15085
15086
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200150878.2.4. Custom log format
15088------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015089
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015090The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015091mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015092
15093HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15094Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15095separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15096prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15097
15098Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15099variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015100("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015101
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015102If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015103as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015104less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15105the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15106
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015107Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015108In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015109in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015110
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015111Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15112'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15113https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15114such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15115
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015116Flags are :
15117 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015118 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015119 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15120 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015121
15122 Example:
15123
15124 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15125 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15126
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015127 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15128
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015129At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15130
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015131 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15132 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015133
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015134the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015135
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015136 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15137 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15138 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015139
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015140and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15141
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015142 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15143 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015144
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015145Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15146
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015147 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015148 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015149 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15150 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15151 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015152 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15153 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15154 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015155 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015156 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15157 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015158 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015159 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15160 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015161 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015162 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015163 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015164 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015165 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015166 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015167 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015168 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15169 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15170 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15171 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15172 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015173 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015174 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15175 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015176 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015177 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15178 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015179 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15180 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15181 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015182 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015183 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15184 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015185 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015186 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15187 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15188 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015189 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015190 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015191 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15192 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15193 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15194 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015195 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015196 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015197 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015198 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015199 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015200 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015201 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15202 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15203 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015204 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015205 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15206 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015207 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015208 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15209 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15210 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015211 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015212 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015213 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015214
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015215 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015216
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015217
152188.2.5. Error log format
15219-----------------------
15220
15221When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15222protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15223By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15224"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15225will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15226logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15227
15228The format looks like this :
15229
15230 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15231 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15232 Connection error during SSL handshake
15233
15234 Field Format Extract from the example above
15235 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15236 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15237 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15238 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15239 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15240
15241These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15242failures.
15243
15244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152458.3. Advanced logging options
15246-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015247
15248Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15249just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15250options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15251for more information about their usage.
15252
15253
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152548.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15255------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015256
15257It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15258haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15259commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15260monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15261ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15262
15263 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15264 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15265 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15266 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15267
15268 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15269 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15270 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015271 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015272 such as other load-balancers.
15273
15274 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15275 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15276 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15277
15278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152798.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15280----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015281
15282The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15283what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15284or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15285"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15286just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15287log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15288after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15289is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15290with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15291with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15292
15293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152948.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15295------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015296
15297Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15298for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15299"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15300retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15301raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15302a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15303file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15304you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15305"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15306
15307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15309--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015310
15311Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15312multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15313them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15314"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15315logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15316error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15317and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15318too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15319useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15320alternative.
15321
15322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153238.4. Timing events
15324------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015325
15326Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15327reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15328the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15329frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015330mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15331addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15332
15333 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15334 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15335 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15336 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15337 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15338 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15339 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015340
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015341 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15342 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15343 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15344 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15345 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15346 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15347 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15348 nothing was received on the connection.
15349
15350 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15351 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15352 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15353 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15354 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15355 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15356 request typed by hand during a test.
15357
15358 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15359 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15360 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15361 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15362 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15363 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15364 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015365
15366 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15367 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15368 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15369 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15370 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15371
15372 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15373 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15374 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15375 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15376 connection never established.
15377
15378 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15379 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15380 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15381 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15382 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15383 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15384 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15385 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15386 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15387 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15388 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15389
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015390 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15391 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15392 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15393 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15394 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15395 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15396
15397 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15398
15399 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15400 "Ta" can never be negative.
15401
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015402 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15403 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015404 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15405 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015406 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015407
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015408 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015409
15410 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015411 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15412 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015413
15414These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15415protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15416that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015417due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15418"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15419that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015420
15421Most common cases :
15422
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015423 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15424 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15425 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15426 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15427 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15428 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15429 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15430 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15431 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15432 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15433 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015434 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015435
15436 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15437 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15438 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15439 of ms on remote networks.
15440
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015441 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15442 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15443 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015444
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015445 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15446 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15447 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15448 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15449 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15450 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15451 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15452 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15453 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015454
15455Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15456
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015457 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015458 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015459 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015460
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015461 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015462 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15463 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15464
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015465 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015466 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15467 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15468 flags.
15469
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015470 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15471 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015472 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15473 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15474 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15475 the client connection was maintained open.
15476
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015477 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015478 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015479 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015480 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15481
15482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154838.5. Session state at disconnection
15484-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015485
15486TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15487"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
154882-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15489each of which has a special meaning :
15490
15491 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15492 session to terminate :
15493
15494 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15495
15496 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15497 server explicitly refused it.
15498
15499 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15500 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15501 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15502 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015503 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15504
15505 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15506 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015507
15508 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15509 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15510 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15511 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15512 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15513
15514 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15515 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15516 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15517 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15518 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15519
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015520 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15521 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15522
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015523 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15524 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15525 backup connections when going up.
15526
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015527 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15528
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015529 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15530 send or receive data.
15531
15532 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15533 send or receive data.
15534
15535 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15536 with nothing left in the buffers.
15537
15538 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15539
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015540 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015541 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15542
15543 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15544 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15545 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15546 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15547 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15548
15549 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15550 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15551
15552 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15553 server (HTTP only).
15554
15555 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15556
15557 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15558 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15559 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15560
15561 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15562 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15563 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15564
15565 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15566
15567 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15568 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15569
15570 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15571 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15572 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15573
15574 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15575 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015576 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15577 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015578
15579 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15580 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15581 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15582 another server.
15583
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015584 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015585 server.
15586
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015587 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15588 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15589 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15590 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15591
15592 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15593 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15594 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15595 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15596
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015597 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15598 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15599 "use-server" rule).
15600
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015601 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15602
15603 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15604 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15605
15606 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15607
15608 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15609 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15610 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15611
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015612 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15613 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015614 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015615 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15616 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15617
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015618 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15619
15620 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15621 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15622
15623 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15624
15625 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15626
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015627The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15628was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015629helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15630starvation, attacks, etc...
15631
15632The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15633alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15634easier finding and understanding.
15635
15636 Flags Reason
15637
15638 -- Normal termination.
15639
15640 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15641 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15642 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15643 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15644
15645 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15646 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15647 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15648 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15649 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15650 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015651
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015652 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15653 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015654 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015655
15656 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15657 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15658 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15659
15660 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15661 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15662 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15663 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15664 the server takes too long to respond.
15665
15666 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15667 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15668 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15669 long a time to respond.
15670
15671 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15672 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15673 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15674 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015675 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15676 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015677
15678 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15679 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15680 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15681 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15682 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015683 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015684 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15685 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15686 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15687 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15688 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15689 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15690 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15691 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15692 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15693 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15694 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15695 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015696
15697 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15698 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015699 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15700 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15701 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
15702 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015703
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015704 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
15705 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
15706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015707 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015708 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
15709 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
15710 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
15711 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
15712 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
15713
15714 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
15715 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
15716 503 or 504 here.
15717
15718 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
15719 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
15720 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
15721 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
15722 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
15723
15724 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15725 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015726 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015727 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
15728 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
15729
15730 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
15731 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
15732 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
15733 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
15734 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
15735 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
15736 between haproxy and the server.
15737
15738 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
15739 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
15740 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
15741 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
15742 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
15743 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
15744 solution is to fix the application.
15745
15746 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
15747 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
15748 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
15749 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
15750 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
15751 external attacks.
15752
15753 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
15754 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015755 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015756 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
15757 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
15758
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015759 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
15760 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
15761 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020015762 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
15763 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015764
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015765 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
15766 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
15767 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
15768 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015769 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
15770 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
15771 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
15772 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
15773 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015774
15775 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
15776 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
15777 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
15778 returned an HTTP 403 error.
15779
15780 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
15781 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
15782 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
15783 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
15784
15785 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
15786 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
15787 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
15788 only be solved by proper system tuning.
15789
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015790The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
15791persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
15792important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
15793re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
15794
15795 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
15796
15797 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15798 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
15799 set on a GET request.
15800
15801 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
15802 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015803 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015804 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
15805
15806 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
15807 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
15808 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
15809
15810 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15811 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
15812 already got a cookie.
15813
15814 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15815 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
15816 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
15817 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
15818 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
15819
15820 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15821 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15822 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15823
15824 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
15825 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15826 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15827
15828 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
15829 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
15830
15831 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
15832 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
15833 then advertised in the response.
15834
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015835
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158368.6. Non-printable characters
15837-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015838
15839In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
15840consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
15841converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
15842prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
15843being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
15844escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
15845is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
15846'}' when logging headers.
15847
15848Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
15849issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
15850containing spaces is "User-Agent".
15851
15852Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
15853the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
15854performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
15855
15856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158578.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
15858---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015859
15860Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
15861achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015862section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015863cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
15864the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
15865the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015866locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015867not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
15868user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
15869a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
15870wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
15871
15872 Examples :
15873 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
15874 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
15875
15876 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
15877 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
15878
15879
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158808.8. Capturing HTTP headers
15881---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015882
15883Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
15884proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
15885the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
15886server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
15887
15888Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
15889response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015890section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015891
15892It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015893time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
15894appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015895are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
15896and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
15897follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
15898request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
15899in the logs.
15900
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015901As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
15902frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
15903an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
15904
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015905 Example :
15906 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
15907 listen proxy-out
15908 mode http
15909 option httplog
15910 option logasap
15911 log global
15912 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
15913
15914 # log the name of the virtual server
15915 capture request header Host len 20
15916
15917 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
15918 capture request header Content-Length len 10
15919
15920 # log the beginning of the referrer
15921 capture request header Referer len 20
15922
15923 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
15924 capture response header Server len 20
15925
15926 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
15927 capture response header Content-Length len 10
15928
15929 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
15930 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
15931
15932 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
15933 capture response header Via len 20
15934
15935 # log the URL location during a redirection
15936 capture response header Location len 20
15937
15938 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
15939 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
15940 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15941 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
15942 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
15943
15944 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15945 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15946 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15947 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015948 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015949
15950 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15951 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15952 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15953 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
15954 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015955 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015956
15957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159588.9. Examples of logs
15959---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015960
15961These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
15962them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
15963reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
15964
15965 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
15966 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15967 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15968
15969 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
15970 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
15971
15972 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
15973 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
15974 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15975
15976 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
15977 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
15978
15979 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
15980 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15981 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
15982
15983 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015984 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015985 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
15986 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
15987
15988 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
15989 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
15990 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
15991
15992 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
15993 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020015994 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015995 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
15996 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
15997 to return the 502 and not the server.
15998
15999 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016000 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016001
16002 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16003 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16004 Nothing was sent to any server.
16005
16006 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16007 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16008
16009 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16010 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16011 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16012 send a 408 return code to the client.
16013
16014 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16015 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16016
16017 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16018 5 seconds ("c----").
16019
16020 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16021 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016022 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016023
16024 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016025 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016026 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16027 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16028 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16029 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16030 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016031
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016032
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200160339. Supported filters
16034--------------------
16035
16036Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16037accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16038unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16039
16040See also : "filter"
16041
160429.1. Trace
16043----------
16044
16045filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding]
16046
16047 Arguments:
16048 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16049 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16050
16051 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16052 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16053 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16054 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16055
16056 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16057 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16058 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16059 amount of the parsed data.
16060
16061This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16062callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16063information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16064filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16065
16066Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16067tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16068a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16069
16070
160719.2. HTTP compression
16072---------------------
16073
16074filter compression
16075
16076The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16077keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16078when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16079use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16080used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16081filters evaluation order.
16082
16083See also : "compression"
16084
16085
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016086/*
16087 * Local variables:
16088 * fill-column: 79
16089 * End:
16090 */